blob: 9ca24361c172801aae338005acd1c38b179b54a9 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauc94431b2020-12-01 08:15:26 +01007 2020/12/01
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200121
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012210. FastCGI applications
12310.1. Setup
12410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12510.1.2. Proxy section
12610.1.3. Example
12710.2. Default parameters
12810.3. Limitations
129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130
1311. Quick reminder about HTTP
132----------------------------
133
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
136on almost anything found in the contents.
137
138However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
139formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
140correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
141
142
1431.1. The HTTP transaction model
144-------------------------------
145
146The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100147to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100148from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
149connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150will involve a new connection :
151
152 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
153
154In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
155establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
156by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
157length.
158
159Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
160to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
161however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
162response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
163header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
168power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
169but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
174second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
175page :
176
177 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
178
179This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
180latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
181correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
182the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100183server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100185The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
186time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
187are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
188parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
189carry the stream identifier.
190
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
192connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
193leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
195processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
196waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200197
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200198HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100199 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
200 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100201 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206
2071.2. HTTP request
208-----------------
209
210First, let's consider this HTTP request :
211
212 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
215 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
216 3 User-agent: my small browser
217 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
218 5 Accept: image/png
219
220
2211.2.1. The Request line
222-----------------------
223
224Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
225
226 - a METHOD : GET
227 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
228 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
229
230All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
231which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
232followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
233is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
234desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
235the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
236
237The URI itself can have several forms :
238
239 - A "relative URI" :
240
241 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
244 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
245
246 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
247
248 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
251 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
252 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
253 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
254 must accept this form too.
255
256 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
257 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
258 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200260 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
261 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
262 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
263 other protocols too.
264
265In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
266mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
267on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
268It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
269specific to the language, framework or application in use.
270
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100271HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100272assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200274
2751.2.2. The request headers
276--------------------------
277
278The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
279beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
280an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
281Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
282values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
283encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
284the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
285define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100287Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100289"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200290as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
291normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
292representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
293HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
295The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
296that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
297is one valid form of empty line.
298
299Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
300headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
301about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
302application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
303
304Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000305 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
307 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
308 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
309
310
3111.3. HTTP response
312------------------
313
314An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
315messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
316
317 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100318 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
320 2 Content-length: 350
321 3 Content-Type: text/html
322
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200323As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
324codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
325response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100326continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
327the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
328following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
329sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
330(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
331correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
332such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
333state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
334over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
335if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
336information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200338
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003391.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340------------------------
341
342Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
343
344 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
345 - a status code : 200
346 - a reason : OK
347
348The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100349 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
350 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
351 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
352 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
353 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000355Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100356"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200357found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
358messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
359or "Authentication Required".
360
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362
363 Code When / reason
364 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
365 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
367 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100368 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370 400 for an invalid or too large request
371 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
372 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200373 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100374 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100376 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
377 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
379 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
380 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200381 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
383 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
384 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
385
386The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3874.2).
388
389
3901.3.2. The response headers
391---------------------------
392
393Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
394the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
395details.
396
397
3982. Configuring HAProxy
399----------------------
400
4012.1. Configuration file format
402------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200403
404HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
405
406 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100407 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
408 - the running process' environment, in case some environment variables are
409 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100411The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
412a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
415
416 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
417
418 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
419 tab characters
420
421 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
422 keyword sequences listed in this document
423
424 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
425 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
426 parts of the configuration, or expressions
427
428 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
429 are supported
430
431 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
432 section
433
434This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
435generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
436figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
437
438First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
439the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
440a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
441word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
442follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
443the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
444the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
445the parts that need to be addressed.
446
447A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
448requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
449extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
450the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
451section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
452section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
453not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
454
455A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
456each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
457a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
458start a new one.
459
460Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
461that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
462applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
463"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
464processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
465ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
466which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
467In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
468of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
469identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
470such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4712, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
472
473 listen foo
474 bind :80
475
476 listen bar
477 bind :81
478
479Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
480spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
481of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
482following configurations are strictly equivalent:
483
484 global#this is the global section
485 daemon#daemonize
486 frontend foo
487 mode http # or tcp
488
489and:
490
491 global
492 daemon
493
494 # this is the public web frontend
495 frontend foo
496 mode http
497
498The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
499new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
500other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
501section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
502section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
503at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
504
505Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
506are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
507editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
508support automatic indent.
509
510In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
511positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
512modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
513anymore, and is not recommended.
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005162.2. Quoting and escaping
517-------------------------
518
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100519In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
520that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
521possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
522in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
523('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200524
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100525This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
526very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
527the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
528also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
529delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
530word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
531remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
534(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
535
536Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
537backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200538
539 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
540 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
541 \\ to use a backslash
542 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
543 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
544
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100545In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
546C-language representation:
547
548 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
549 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
550 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
551 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
552
553Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
554or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
555of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200556
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100557 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200558 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
559 # hash as a comment start
560
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100561Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
562evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
563dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
564backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200565
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
567character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
568is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
571entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
572name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
573represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
574hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200575
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100576 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
577 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
578 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
579 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
580 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
581 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
582 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
583 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
584 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
585 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
586 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200587
588 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100589 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
591 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
592 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
593 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
594 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
595
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
597necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
598by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
599they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
600escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
601characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
602case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
603if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
604own quotes.
605
606The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
607quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
608not always obvious is that the delimitors used inside must first be escaped or
609quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
610
611Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
612arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
613
614 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
615 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
616
617Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
618"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
619cannot write:
620
621 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
622
623because we would like the string to cut like this:
624
625 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
626 |---------|----|-|
627 arg1 _/ / /
628 arg2 __________/ /
629 arg3 ______________/
630
631but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
632parenthesis then garbage:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |--------|--------|
636 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
637 trailing garbage _________/
638
639The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
640quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
641processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
642this word:
643
644 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
645 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
646 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
647
648So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
649still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
650the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
651the second level:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
656 |---------||----|-|
657 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
658 arg2=blah ___________/ /
659 arg3=g _______________/
660
661Another approch consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
662double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
663
664 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
665 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
666 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
667 |---------||----|-|
668 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
669 arg2 ___________/ /
670 arg3 _______________/
671
672When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
673appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
674string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
675thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
676
677 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
678 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
679 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
680 |-------------| |-----||-|
681 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
682 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
683 arg3 ______________________/
684
685Remember that backslahes are not escape characters withing single quotes and
686that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
687quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
688single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
689level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
690
691When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
692double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
693and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
694a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
695a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
696the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
697regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
698around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
699more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200700
701
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007022.3. Environment variables
703--------------------------
704
705HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
706interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
707configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
708optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
709shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200710underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
711list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
712arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
713before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200714
715 Example:
716
717 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
718
719 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
720
721 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
722
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200723Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
724file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200725
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200726* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
727 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
728
729* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
730 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
731 directory.
732
733* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
734
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500735* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200736 processes, separated by semicolons.
737
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500738* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739 CLI, separated by semicolons.
740
741See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200742
7432.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200744----------------
745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100746Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100747values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
748otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
749numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
750for every keyword. Supported units are :
751
752 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
753 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
754 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
755 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
756 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
757 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
758
759
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00007602.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200761-------------
762
763 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
764 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
765 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
766 global
767 daemon
768 maxconn 256
769
770 defaults
771 mode http
772 timeout connect 5000ms
773 timeout client 50000ms
774 timeout server 50000ms
775
776 frontend http-in
777 bind *:80
778 default_backend servers
779
780 backend servers
781 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
782
783
784 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
785 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
786 global
787 daemon
788 maxconn 256
789
790 defaults
791 mode http
792 timeout connect 5000ms
793 timeout client 50000ms
794 timeout server 50000ms
795
796 listen http-in
797 bind *:80
798 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
799
800
801Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
802
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100803 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200804
805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008063. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200807--------------------
808
809Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
810are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
811of them have command-line equivalents.
812
813The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
814
815 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200816 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200818 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200819 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200821 - description
822 - deviceatlas-json-file
823 - deviceatlas-log-level
824 - deviceatlas-separator
825 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900826 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200827 - gid
828 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100829 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200830 - h1-case-adjust
831 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100832 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100833 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100834 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200835 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200836 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200837 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100838 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200839 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100840 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100841 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200842 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200843 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200844 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200845 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200846 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200847 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100848 - presetenv
849 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200850 - uid
851 - ulimit-n
852 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200853 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100854 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200855 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200856 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200857 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200858 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200859 - ssl-default-bind-options
860 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200861 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200862 - ssl-default-server-options
863 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100864 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200865 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100866 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100867 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100868 - 51degrees-data-file
869 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200870 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200871 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200872 - wurfl-data-file
873 - wurfl-information-list
874 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200875 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100876 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100877
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200878 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100879 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200880 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200881 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200882 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100883 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100884 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100885 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200886 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200887 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200888 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200889 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200890 - noepoll
891 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000892 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200893 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100894 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300895 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000896 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100897 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200898 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200899 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200900 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000901 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000902 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200903 - tune.buffers.limit
904 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200905 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200906 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100907 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200908 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200909 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200910 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200911 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100912 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200913 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200914 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200915 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100916 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100917 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100918 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100919 - tune.lua.session-timeout
920 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200921 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100922 - tune.maxaccept
923 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200924 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200925 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200926 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200927 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
928 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100929 - tune.rcvbuf.client
930 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100931 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200932 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200933 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100934 - tune.sndbuf.client
935 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100936 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200937 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100938 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200939 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100940 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200941 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200942 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100943 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200944 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100945 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200946 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
947 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
948 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100949 - tune.zlib.memlevel
950 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100951
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200953 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200954 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200955
956
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009573.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200958------------------------------------
959
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200960ca-base <dir>
961 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100962 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
963 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
964 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200965
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200966chroot <jail dir>
967 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
968 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
969 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
970 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
971 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100972 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100973
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100974cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
975 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
976 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
977 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
978 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
979 set. These sets have the format
980
981 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
982
983 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100984 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100985 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
986 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100987 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
988 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100989 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100990 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100991 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100992 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100993 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
994 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
995 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
996 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100997
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100998 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
999 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1000 on the machine's word size.
1001
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001002 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001003 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1004 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1005 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1006 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1007 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1008 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001009
1010 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001011 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1012
1013 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1014 # first 4 CPUs
1015
1016 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1017 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1018 # word size.
1019
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001020 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001021 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001022 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1023 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1024 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1025
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001026 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1027 # and so on.
1028 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1029 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1030 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1031
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001032 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001033 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1034 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1035 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1036
1037 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1038 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1039 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1040
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001041 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1042 # and a thread range.
1043 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1044 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1045 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1046
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001047crt-base <dir>
1048 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001049 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1050 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001051
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001052daemon
1053 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1054 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001055 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1056 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001057
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001058deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1059 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001060 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001061
1062deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001063 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001064 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1065
1066deviceatlas-separator <char>
1067 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1068 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1069
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001070deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001071 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1072 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1073 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001074
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001075external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001076 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1077 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001078 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1079 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1080 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1081 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1082 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001083
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001084gid <number>
1085 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
1086 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1087 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001088 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1089 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001090 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001091
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001092group <group name>
1093 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1094 See also "gid" and "user".
1095
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001096hard-stop-after <time>
1097 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1098
1099 Arguments :
1100 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1101 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1102 SIGUSR1 signal.
1103
1104 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1105 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1106 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1107
1108 Example:
1109 global
1110 hard-stop-after 30s
1111
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001112h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1113 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1114 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1115 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1116 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001117 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001118 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1119 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1120 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1121 specified in a proxy.
1122
1123 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1124 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1125 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1126 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1127 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1128 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1129 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1130
1131 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1132 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1133 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1134 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1135 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1136
1137 Example:
1138 global
1139 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1140
1141 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1142 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1143
1144h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1145 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1146 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1147 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1148 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1149 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1150 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1151 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1152 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1153
1154 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1155 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1156 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1157
1158 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1159 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1160
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001161insecure-fork-wanted
1162 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1163 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1164 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1165 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1166 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1167 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1168 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1169 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1170 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1171 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1172 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1173 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1174 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1175 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1176 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1177 disable it.
1178
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001179insecure-setuid-wanted
1180 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1181 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1182 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1183 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1184 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1185 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1186 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1187 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1188 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1189 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1190 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1191 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1192 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1193 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1194
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001195issuers-chain-path <dir>
1196 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1197 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1198 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1199 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1200 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1201 "issuers-chain-path".
1202 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1203 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1204 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1205 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1206 will share the chain in memory.
1207
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001208localpeer <name>
1209 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1210 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1211 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1212 the configuration parsing.
1213
1214 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1215 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1216
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001217log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
1218 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001219 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001220 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001221 configured with "log global".
1222
1223 <address> can be one of:
1224
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001225 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001226 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1227 port).
1228
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001229 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1230 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1231 port).
1232
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001233 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001234 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1235 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001236 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001237
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001238 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1239 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1240 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1241 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1242 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1243 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1244 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1245 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1246 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1247 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1248 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1249 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1250 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1251 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001252 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1253 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001254
1255 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1256 "fd@2", see above.
1257
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001258 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1259 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1260 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1261 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1262 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1263
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001264 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1265 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001266
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001267 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1268 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1269 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1270 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1271 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1272 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1273 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1274 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1275 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1276 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001277 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1278 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001279
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001280 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1281 one of the following :
1282
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001283 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1284 field is stripped. This is the default.
1285 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1286 rfc3164.
1287
1288 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001289 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1290
1291 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1292 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1293
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001294 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1295 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1296 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1297 designed to be used with a local log server.
1298
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001299 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1300 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1301 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1302 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1303 logger consumes.
1304
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001305 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1306 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1307 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1308 used with a local log server.
1309
1310 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1311 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1312 designed to be used with a local log server.
1313
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001314 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1315 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1316 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1317 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1318
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001319 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1320 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1321 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1322 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1323 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1324
1325 <sample_size>
1326 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1327 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1328 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1329 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1330 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1331
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001332 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001333
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001334 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1335 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1336 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1337
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001338 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1339 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1340 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1341 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001342
1343 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001344 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1345 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1346 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1347 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1348 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1349 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001350
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001351 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001352
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001353log-send-hostname [<string>]
1354 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1355 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1356 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1357 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1358 the logs.
1359
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001360log-tag <string>
1361 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1362 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1363 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001364 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001365
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001366lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001367 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1368 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1369 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1370 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1371 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1372 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001373 used multiple times.
1374
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001375lua-load-per-thread <file>
1376 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1377 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1378 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1379 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1380 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1381 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1382 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1383 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1384 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1385 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1386 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1387 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1388 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1389 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1390 times.
1391
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001392lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1393 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1394 variable.
1395 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1396 to "path".
1397
1398 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1399 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1400 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1401 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1402 will be checked earlier.
1403
1404 As an example by specifying the following path:
1405
1406 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1407 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1408
1409 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1410 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1411 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1412 paths if that does not exist either.
1413
1414 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1415 documentation.
1416
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001417master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001418 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1419 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1420 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001421 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001422 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1423 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001424 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1425 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1426 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1427 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1428 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001429
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001430 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001431
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001432mworker-max-reloads <number>
1433 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001434 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001435 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1436 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1437 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1438
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001439nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001440 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1441 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1442 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001443 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1444 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001445 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1446 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1447 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001448
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001449nbthread <number>
1450 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001451 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1452 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1453 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1454 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1455 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001456 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1457 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1458 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1459 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1460 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1461 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1462 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001463
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001464pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001465 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1466 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1467 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1468 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001469
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001470pp2-never-send-local
1471 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1472 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1473 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1474 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1475 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1476 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1477 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1478 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1479 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1480 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1481 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1482
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001483presetenv <name> <value>
1484 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1485 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1486 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1487 and "unsetenv".
1488
1489resetenv [<name> ...]
1490 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1491 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1492 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1493 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1494 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1495 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1496 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1497 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1498
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001499stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001500 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1501 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1502 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1503 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1504 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1505 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001506 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001507 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1508 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1509 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1510 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001511
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001512server-state-base <directory>
1513 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001514 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1515 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001516
1517server-state-file <file>
1518 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1519 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1520 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1521 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1522 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1523 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1524 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1525 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001526 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1527 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001528
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001529setenv <name> <value>
1530 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1531 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1532 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1533 and "unsetenv".
1534
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001535set-dumpable
1536 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001537 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1538 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1539 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1540 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1541 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1542 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1543 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1544 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1545 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1546 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1547 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1548 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1549 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1550 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1551 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1552 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1553 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001554
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001555ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1556 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1557 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001558 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001559 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001560 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1561 information and recommendations see e.g.
1562 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1563 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1564 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1565 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001566
1567ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1568 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1569 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1570 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1571 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1572 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001573 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1574 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1575 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001576 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001577
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001578ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1579 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1580 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1581 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1582 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1583 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1584
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001585ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1586 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1587 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1588 keyword to see available options.
1589
1590 Example:
1591 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001592 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001593
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001594ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1595 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1596 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001597 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001598 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001599 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1600 information and recommendations see e.g.
1601 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1602 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1603 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1604 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1605 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001606
1607ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1608 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1609 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1610 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1611 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1612 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001613 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1614 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1615 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1616 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001617
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001618ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1619 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1620 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1621 keyword to see available options.
1622
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001623ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1624 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1625 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1626 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001627 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001628 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001629 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1630 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1631 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1632 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001633 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1634 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1635 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1636
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001637ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1638 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1639 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001640 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001641 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001642 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1643
1644 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001645
1646 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1647 and won't try to remove them.
1648
1649 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1650
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001651ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001652 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001653 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1654 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001655
1656 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1657 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1658 optimize the startup time.
1659
1660 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1661 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1662 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1663
1664 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001665 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001666
1667 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001668 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1669
1670 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1671 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1672 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1673 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1674 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1675 bind configuration..
1676
1677 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1678 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1679 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1680 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1681 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1682 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1683 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1684 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1685
1686 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1687
1688 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1689 a cert bundle.
1690
1691 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1692 separately in several "crt".
1693
1694 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1695 since files are loading separately.
1696
1697 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1698 required to commit them.
1699
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001700 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001701 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001702
1703 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1704
1705 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1706
1707 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1708 not provided in the PEM file.
1709
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001710 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1711 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1712
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001713 The default behavior is "all".
1714
1715 Example:
1716 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1717 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1718 ssl-load-extra-files none
1719
1720 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1721
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001722ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1723 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1724 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1725 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1726
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001727ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001728 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001729 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1730 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1731 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1732 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1733 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1734 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001735 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001736
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001737stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1738 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1739 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1740 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001741 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001742 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001743
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001744 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1745 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1746 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001747
1748stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1749 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1750 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001751 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001752
1753stats maxconn <connections>
1754 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1755 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1756
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001757uid <number>
1758 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1759 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1760 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1761 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1762
1763ulimit-n <number>
1764 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1765 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1766 option.
1767
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001768unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1769 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1770
1771 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1772 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1773 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1774 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1775 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1776 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1777 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1778 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1779 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1780 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1781
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001782unsetenv [<name> ...]
1783 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1784 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1785 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1786 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1787 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1788 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1789 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1790
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001791user <user name>
1792 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1793 See also "uid" and "group".
1794
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001795node <name>
1796 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1797
1798 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1799 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1800 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1801 traffic.
1802
1803description <text>
1804 Add a text that describes the instance.
1805
1806 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1807 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1808 "<" and ">" characters.
1809
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100181051degrees-data-file <file path>
1811 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001812 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001813
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001814 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001815 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1816
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000181751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001818 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1819 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1820 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1821
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001822 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001823 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1824
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200182551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001826 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1827 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1828
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001829 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1830 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1831
183251degrees-cache-size <number>
1833 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1834 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1835 By default, this cache is disabled.
1836
1837 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001838 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1839
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001840wurfl-data-file <file path>
1841 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1842 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1843
1844 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1845 with USE_WURFL=1.
1846
1847wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1848 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1849 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1850 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1851
1852 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1853
1854 Valid WURFL properties are:
1855 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1856
1857 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1858 device.
1859
1860 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1861 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1862
1863 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1864 particular web request.
1865
1866 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1867 used Libwurfl API version.
1868
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001869 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1870 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1871
1872 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1873 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1874
1875 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1876
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001877 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1878 with USE_WURFL=1.
1879
1880wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1881 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1882 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1883
1884 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1885 with USE_WURFL=1.
1886
1887wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1888 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1889 thus before the chroot.
1890
1891 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1892 with USE_WURFL=1.
1893
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001894wurfl-cache-size <size>
1895 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1896 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001897 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001898 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001899
1900 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1901 with USE_WURFL=1.
1902
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001903strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001904 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1905 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1906 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1907 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1908 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019103.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001911-----------------------
1912
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001913busy-polling
1914 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1915 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1916 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1917 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1918 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1919 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1920 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1921 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1922 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1923 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1924 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1925 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1926 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1927 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1928 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1929 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1930 "poll" pollers.
1931
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001932 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1933 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1934 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1935
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001936max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1937 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1938 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1939 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1940 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1941 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1942 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1943 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1944 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1945
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001946maxconn <number>
1947 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1948 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1949 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001950 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1951 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1952 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1953 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001954 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1955 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1956 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1957 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1958 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1959 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001960
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001961maxconnrate <number>
1962 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1963 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1964 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1965 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1966 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1967 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1968 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1969 fairness.
1970
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001971maxcomprate <number>
1972 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001973 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001974 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1975 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1976 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001977 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001978 default value.
1979
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001980maxcompcpuusage <number>
1981 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1982 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1983 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1984 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1985 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1986 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1987 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1988 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1989
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001990maxpipes <number>
1991 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1992 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1993 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1994 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1995 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1996 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1997
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001998maxsessrate <number>
1999 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2000 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2001 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2002 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2003 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2004 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2005 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2006 fairness.
2007
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002008maxsslconn <number>
2009 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2010 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2011 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2012 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2013 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2014 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2015 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002016 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2017 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2018 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2019 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2020 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2021 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2022 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002023
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002024maxsslrate <number>
2025 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2026 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2027 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2028 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2029 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2030 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2031 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2032 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2033 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2034 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2035
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002036maxzlibmem <number>
2037 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2038 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2039 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002040 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2041 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2042 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2043
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002044noepoll
2045 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2046 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002047 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002048
2049nokqueue
2050 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2051 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2052 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2053
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002054noevports
2055 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2056 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2057 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2058 also "nopoll".
2059
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002060nopoll
2061 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2062 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002063 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002064 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2065 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002066
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002067nosplice
2068 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002069 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002070 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002071 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002072 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2073 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2074 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2075 "option splice-response".
2076
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002077nogetaddrinfo
2078 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2079 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2080
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002081noreuseport
2082 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2083 command line argument "-dR".
2084
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002085profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2086 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2087 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2088 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2089 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002090 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002091 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2092 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2093 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2094 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2095
2096 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2097 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2098 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2099 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2100 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002101 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2102 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2103 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2104 CLI.
2105
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002106spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002107 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2108 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2109 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2110 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2111 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2112 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002113
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002114ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002115 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002116 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002117 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2118 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2119 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2120 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2121 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002122 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2123 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002124 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2125 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2126 openssl configuration file uses:
2127 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2128
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002129ssl-mode-async
2130 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002131 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002132 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2133 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2134 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002135 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002136 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002137
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002138tune.buffers.limit <number>
2139 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2140 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2141 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2142 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2143 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002144 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002145 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2146 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2147 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2148 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2149 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2150 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2151 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2152 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2153 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2154
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002155tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2156 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2157 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2158 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2159 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2160
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002161tune.bufsize <number>
2162 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2163 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2164 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2165 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2166 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2167 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2168 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002169 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2170 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2171 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002172 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002173 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2174 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2175 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002176
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002177tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2178 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002179
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002180tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2181 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2182 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2183 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2184 this value. The default value is 1.
2185
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002186tune.fail-alloc
2187 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2188 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2189 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2190 gracefully.
2191
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002192tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2193 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2194 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2195 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2196 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2197 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2198
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002199tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2200 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2201 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2202 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2203 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2204 change it.
2205
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002206tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2207 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002208 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2209 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002210 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2211 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2212 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2213 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2214 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2215
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002216tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2217 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2218 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2219 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2220 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2221 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2222 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2223 recommended not to change this value.
2224
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002225tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2226 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2227 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2228 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2229 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2230 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2231 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2232 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2233
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002234tune.http.cookielen <number>
2235 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2236 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2237 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2238 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2239 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2240 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2241 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2242 to change this value.
2243
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002244tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002245 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2246 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002247 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002248 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002249 configuration directives too.
2250 The default value is 1024.
2251
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002252tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2253 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2254 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2255 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2256 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2257 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2258 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002259 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2260 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2261 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002262
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002263tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2264 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2265 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2266 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2267 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2268 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2269 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
2270 this option to "off". The default is on.
2271
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002272tune.idletimer <timeout>
2273 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2274 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2275 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2276 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2277 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2278 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002279 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002280 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002281 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2282
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002283tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2284 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2285 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2286 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2287 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2288 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2289 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2290 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2291 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2292 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2293
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002294tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2295 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002296 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002297 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2298 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002299 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002300 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2301 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2302
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002303tune.lua.maxmem
2304 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2305 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2306 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2307 memory.
2308
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002309tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2310 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002311 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2312 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002313 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002314
2315tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2316 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2317 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2318 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2319 check servers.
2320
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002321tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2322 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2323 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2324 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002325 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002326
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002327tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002328 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2329 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2330 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2331 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2332 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2333 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2334 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2335 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2336 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2337 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002338
2339tune.maxpollevents <number>
2340 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2341 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2342 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2343 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2344 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2345
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002346tune.maxrewrite <number>
2347 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2348 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2349 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2350 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2351 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2352 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2353 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2354 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2355 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2356 bufsize.
2357
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002358tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2359 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2360 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2361 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2362 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2363 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2364 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2365 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2366 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2367 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002368 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2369 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002370 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2371 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2372 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2373 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2374 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2375 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2376 setting this parameter to 0.
2377
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002378tune.pipesize <number>
2379 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2380 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2381 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2382 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2383 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2384 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2385
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002386tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2387 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2388 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2389 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2390 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2391 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2392 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002393 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002394
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002395tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2396 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2397 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2398 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2399 default is 20.
2400
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002401tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2402tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2403 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2404 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2405 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002406 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002407 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002408 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2409 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2410
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002411tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002412 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002413 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2414 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2415 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2416 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2417
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002418tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002419 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002420 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002421 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2422 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2423 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2424
2425tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2426 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2427 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2428 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2429 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2430 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2431 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2432 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2433 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2434 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002435
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002436tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2437tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2438 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2439 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2440 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002441 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002442 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002443 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2444 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2445 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2446 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2447 notifying haproxy again.
2448
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002449tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002450 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2451 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2452 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002453 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002454 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002455 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002456 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2457 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2458 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002459 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2460 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002461
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002462tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002463 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002464 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2465 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2466 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2467 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2468 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2469
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002470tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2471 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2472 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2473 performances. This is disabled by default.
2474
2475 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2476 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2477
2478 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2479
2480 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2481
2482 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2483
2484 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2485 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2486 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2487
2488 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2489 converted.
2490
2491 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2492 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2493 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2494 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2495 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2496 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2497 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002498 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2499 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002500
2501 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2502
2503 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2504 only need this line:
2505
2506 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2507
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002508tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2509 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002510 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002511 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2512 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2513 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2514 being used for too long.
2515
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002516tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2517 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2518 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2519 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2520 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2521 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2522 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2523 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2524 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2525 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2526 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002527 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002528 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002529
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002530tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2531 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2532 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2533 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2534 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002535 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002536 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2537 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002538 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2539 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002540
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002541tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2542 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2543 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2544 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2545 1000 entries.
2546
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002547tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2548 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2549 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2550 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2551
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002552tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002553tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002554tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2555tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2556tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002557 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2558 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2559 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2560 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2561 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2562 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2563 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2564 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002565
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002566 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2567 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2568 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2569 all available space is consumed.
2570 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2571 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2572 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002573
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002574tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2575 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002576 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002577 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002578 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002579 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2580
2581tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2582 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2583 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002584 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2585 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025873.3. Debugging
2588--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002589
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002590quiet
2591 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2592 line argument "-q".
2593
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002594zero-warning
2595 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2596 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2597 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2598 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2599 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2600 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2601
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002602
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010026033.4. Userlists
2604--------------
2605It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2606http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2607it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2608
2609userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002610 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002611 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2612
2613group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002614 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002615 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2616 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2617
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002618user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2619 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002620 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2621 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002622 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2623 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2624 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2625 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002626
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002627 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2628 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2629 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2630 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2631 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2632 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2633 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2634 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2635 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002636
2637 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002638 userlist L1
2639 group G1 users tiger,scott
2640 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002641
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002642 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2643 user scott insecure-password elgato
2644 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002645
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002646 userlist L2
2647 group G1
2648 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002649
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002650 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2651 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2652 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002653
2654 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002655
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002656
26573.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002658----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002659It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2660several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2661instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2662values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2663automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2664In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2665using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2666tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2667reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2668Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2669that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2670each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002671
2672peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002673 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002674 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2675
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002676bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2677 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2678 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2679
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002680disabled
2681 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2682 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2683 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2684
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002685default-bind [param*]
2686 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2687
2688default-server [param*]
2689 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2690
2691 Arguments:
2692 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2693 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2694 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2695 details.
2696
2697
2698 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2699
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002700enable
2701 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2702
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002703log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2704 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2705 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2706 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2707 more details.
2708
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002709peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002710 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2711 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002712 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2713 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2714 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2715 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2716 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002717
2718 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2719 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2720
2721 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002722 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2723 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2724 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002725
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002726 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2727 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002728
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002729 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2730 "server" keyword explanation below).
2731
2732server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002733 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002734 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2735 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2736 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2737 of this "peers" section).
2738 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2739
2740
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002741 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002742 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002743 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002744 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2745 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2746 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002747
2748 backend mybackend
2749 mode tcp
2750 balance roundrobin
2751 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2752 stick on src
2753
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002754 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2755 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002756
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002757 Example:
2758 peers mypeers
2759 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2760 default-server ssl verify none
2761 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2762 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002763
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002764
2765table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2766 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2767
2768 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2769 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002770 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002771 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2772 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2773 "stick-table" keyword).
2774
2775 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2776 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2777 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2778 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2779 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2780 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2781 of the stick-table name as follows:
2782
2783 peers mypeers
2784 peer A ...
2785 peer B ...
2786 table t1 ...
2787
2788 frontend fe1
2789 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2790
2791 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2792 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2793
2794 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2795 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2796 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2797 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2798 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2799 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2800 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2801
2802 peers mypeers
2803 peer A ...
2804 peer B ...
2805 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2806
2807 backend t1
2808 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2809
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002810 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002811 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2812 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2813
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090028143.6. Mailers
2815------------
2816It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2817If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2818in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2819
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002820mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002821 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2822 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2823
2824mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2825 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2826
2827 Example:
2828 mailers mymailers
2829 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2830 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2831
2832 backend mybackend
2833 mode tcp
2834 balance roundrobin
2835
2836 email-alert mailers mymailers
2837 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2838 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2839
2840 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2841 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2842
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002843timeout mail <time>
2844 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2845 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2846 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2847 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2848
2849 Example:
2850 mailers mymailers
2851 timeout mail 20s
2852 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002853
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020028543.7. Programs
2855-------------
2856In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2857master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2858managed the same way as the workers.
2859
2860During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2861sequence as a worker:
2862
2863 - the master is re-executed
2864 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2865 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2866 instance of the program
2867
2868During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2869
2870program <name>
2871 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2872 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2873 the management guide).
2874
2875command <command> [arguments*]
2876 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2877 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2878 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2879 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2880
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002881user <user name>
2882 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2883 See also "group".
2884
2885group <group name>
2886 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2887 See also "user".
2888
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002889option start-on-reload
2890no option start-on-reload
2891 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2892 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2893 program section.
2894
2895
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010028963.8. HTTP-errors
2897----------------
2898
2899It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2900imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2901several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2902
2903http-errors <name>
2904 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2905 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2906
2907errorfile <code> <file>
2908 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2909
2910 Arguments :
2911 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002912 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2913 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002914
2915 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2916 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2917 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2918 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2919 before any chroot is performed.
2920
2921 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2922
2923 Example:
2924 http-errors website-1
2925 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2926 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2927 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2928
2929 http-errors website-2
2930 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2931 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2932 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2933
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020029343.9. Rings
2935----------
2936
2937It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2938servers or traces.
2939
2940ring <ringname>
2941 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2942
2943description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002944 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002945 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2946
2947format <format>
2948 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2949
2950 Arguments:
2951 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2952 one of the following :
2953
2954 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2955 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2956 designed to be used with a local log server.
2957
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01002958 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
2959 field is stripped. This is the default.
2960 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
2961 rfc3164.
2962
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002963 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2964 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2965 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2966 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2967 is the default.
2968
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01002969 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002970 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2971
2972 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2973 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2974
2975 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2976 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2977 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2978 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2979 logger consumes.
2980
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002981 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2982 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2983 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2984 with a local log server.
2985
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002986 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2987 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2988 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2989 used with a local log server.
2990
2991maxlen <length>
2992 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2993 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2994 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2995
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002996server <name> <address> [param*]
2997 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2998 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2999 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3000 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3001 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3002 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3003 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3004 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3005 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003006 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3007 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003008
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003009size <size>
3010 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3011 set to BUFSIZE.
3012
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003013timeout connect <timeout>
3014 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3015
3016 Arguments :
3017 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3018 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3019 as explained at the top of this document.
3020
3021timeout server <timeout>
3022 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3023
3024 Arguments :
3025 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3026 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3027 as explained at the top of this document.
3028
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003029 Example:
3030 global
3031 log ring@myring local7
3032
3033 ring myring
3034 description "My local buffer"
3035 format rfc3164
3036 maxlen 1200
3037 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003038 timeout connect 5s
3039 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003040 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003041
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020030423.10. Log forwarding
3043-------------------
3044
3045It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3046haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3047
3048log-forward <name>
3049 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3050
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003051backlog <conns>
3052 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3053 on connections accept.
3054
3055bind <addr> [param*]
3056 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003057 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3058 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3059 syslog protocol over TCP.
3060 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003061 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3062
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003063dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003064 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3065 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3066 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3067 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003068 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003069
3070log global
3071log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
3072 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3073 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3074 documentation.
3075 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3076 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3077 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3078 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3079 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3080
3081 Example:
3082 global
3083 log stderr format iso local7
3084
3085 ring myring
3086 description "My local buffer"
3087 format rfc5424
3088 maxlen 1200
3089 size 32764
3090 timeout connect 5s
3091 timeout server 10s
3092 # syslog tcp server
3093 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3094
3095 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003096 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3097 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003098 # all messages on stderr
3099 log global
3100 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3101 log ring@myring local0
3102 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3103 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3104 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3105 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3106 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003107
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003108maxconn <conns>
3109 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3110 10 is the default.
3111
3112timeout client <timeout>
3113 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031154. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003116----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003117
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003118Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02003119 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003120 - frontend <name>
3121 - backend <name>
3122 - listen <name>
3123
3124A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
3125its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
3126section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003127section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003128
3129A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3130connections.
3131
3132A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3133to forward incoming connections.
3134
3135A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3136parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3137
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3139'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3140case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3141
3142Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3143logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3144proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3145However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3146name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3147
3148Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3149and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003150bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003151protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3152modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3153arbitrary criteria.
3154
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003155In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3156a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003157the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003158
3159 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3160 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3161 between responses and new requests.
3162
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003163 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3164 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3165 client-facing connection remains open.
3166
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003167 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3168 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003169
3170The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3171frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3172following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003173weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003174
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003175 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003176
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003177 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3178 ----+-----+-----+----
3179 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3180 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003181 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3182 ----+-----+-----+----
3183 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003184
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003185
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031874.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3188--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003189
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003190The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3191limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3192they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3193limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003194marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003195option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003196and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3197with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3198specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003199
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003200
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003201 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3202------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3203acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003204backlog X X X -
3205balance X - X X
3206bind - X X -
3207bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003208capture cookie - X X -
3209capture request header - X X -
3210capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003211clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3212clitcpka-idle X X X -
3213clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003214compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003215cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003216declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003217default-server X - X X
3218default_backend X X X -
3219description - X X X
3220disabled X X X X
3221dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003222email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003223email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003224email-alert mailers X X X X
3225email-alert myhostname X X X X
3226email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003227enabled X X X X
3228errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003229errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003230errorloc X X X X
3231errorloc302 X X X X
3232-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3233errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003234force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003235filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003236fullconn X - X X
3237grace X X X X
3238hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003239http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003240http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003241http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003242http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003243http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003244http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003245http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003246http-check set-var X - X X
3247http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003248http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003249http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003250http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003251http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003252http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003253id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003254ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003255load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003256log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003257log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003258log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003259log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003260max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003261maxconn X X X -
3262mode X X X X
3263monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003264monitor-uri X X X -
3265option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3266option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3267option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3268option allbackups (*) X - X X
3269option checkcache (*) X - X X
3270option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3271option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003272option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003273option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3274option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003275-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3276option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003277option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3278option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003279option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003280option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003281option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003282option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003283option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003284option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3285option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3286option httpchk X - X X
3287option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003288option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003289option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003290option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003291option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003292option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003293option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3294option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3295option logasap (*) X X X -
3296option mysql-check X - X X
3297option nolinger (*) X X X X
3298option originalto X X X X
3299option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003300option pgsql-check X - X X
3301option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003302option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003303option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003304option smtpchk X - X X
3305option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3306option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3307option splice-request (*) X X X X
3308option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003309option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003310option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3311option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3312-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003313option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003314option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3315option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3316option tcpka X X X X
3317option tcplog X X X X
3318option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003319external-check command X - X X
3320external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003321persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3322rate-limit sessions X X X -
3323redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003324-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003325retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003326retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003327server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003328server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003329server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003330source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003331srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3332srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3333srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003334stats admin - X X X
3335stats auth X X X X
3336stats enable X X X X
3337stats hide-version X X X X
3338stats http-request - X X X
3339stats realm X X X X
3340stats refresh X X X X
3341stats scope X X X X
3342stats show-desc X X X X
3343stats show-legends X X X X
3344stats show-node X X X X
3345stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003346-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3347stick match - - X X
3348stick on - - X X
3349stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003350stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003351stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003352tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003353tcp-check connect X - X X
3354tcp-check expect X - X X
3355tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003356tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003357tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003358tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003359tcp-check set-var X - X X
3360tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003361tcp-request connection - X X -
3362tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003363tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003364tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003365tcp-response content - - X X
3366tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003367timeout check X - X X
3368timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003369timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003370timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003371timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3372timeout http-request X X X X
3373timeout queue X - X X
3374timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003375timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003376timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003377timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003378transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003379unique-id-format X X X -
3380unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003381use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003382use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003383use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003384------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3385 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003386
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003387
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033884.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3389---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003390
3391This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3392
3393
3394acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3395 Declare or complete an access list.
3396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3397 no | yes | yes | yes
3398 Example:
3399 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3400 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3401 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3402
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003403 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003404
3405
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003406backlog <conns>
3407 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3409 yes | yes | yes | no
3410 Arguments :
3411 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3412 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003413 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003414
3415 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3416 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3417 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3418 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3419 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3420 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3421 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3422 backlog parameter.
3423
3424 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3425 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3426 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3427
3428 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3429
3430
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003431balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003432balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003433 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3435 yes | no | yes | yes
3436 Arguments :
3437 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3438 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3439 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3440 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3441
3442 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3443 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3444 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3445 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003446 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003447 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003448 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3449 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3450 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3451 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3452 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3453 it, so that you don't worry.
3454
3455 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3456 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3457 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3458 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3459 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3460 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3461 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3462 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003463
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003464 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3465 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3466 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3467 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3468 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3469 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3470 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003471 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3472 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3473 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003474
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003475 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003476 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003477 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3478 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003479 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003480 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3481 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3482 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3483 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3484 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003485 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3486 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3487 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3488 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3489 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3490 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003491
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003492 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3493 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3494 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3495 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3496 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3497 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3498 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3499 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003500 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003501 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003502 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3503 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3504 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003505
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003506 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3507 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3508 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3509 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3510 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3511 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3512 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3513 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3514 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3515 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3516 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3517 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003518
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003519 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003520 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3521 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3522 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3523 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3524 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3525 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3526 URIs start with a leading "/".
3527
3528 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3529 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3530 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3531 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3532
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003533 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3534 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3535 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3536 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3537
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003538 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003539 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3540
3541 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003542 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3543 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003544 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3545 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3546 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3547 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003548 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003549 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3550 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003551
3552 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3553 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3554 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3555 server will receive the request.
3556
3557 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3558 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3559 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3560 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3561 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003562 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3563 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3564 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003565
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003566 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3567 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3568 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3569 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3570 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003571
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003572 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003573 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3574 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3575 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3576
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003577 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3578 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3579 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3580
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003581 random
3582 random(<draws>)
3583 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003584 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3585 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3586 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3587 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003588 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3589 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3590 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3591 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3592 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3593 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3594 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3595 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3596 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3597 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3598 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3599 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3600 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3601 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3602 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3603 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3604 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3605 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3606 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3607 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003608
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003609 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003610 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003611 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3612 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3613 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3614 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3615 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3616 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003617 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003618 used instead.
3619
3620 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3621 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3622 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3623 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3624
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003625 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3626 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3627 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3628
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003629 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003630
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003631 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003632 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3633 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003634
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003635 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3636 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3637 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003638
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003639 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003640 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003641 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3642 NTLM relies on.
3643
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003644 Examples :
3645 balance roundrobin
3646 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003647 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003648 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3649 balance hdr(host)
3650 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003651
3652 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3653 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3654
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003655 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003656 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3657 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3658 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003659 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003660
3661 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3662 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3663 defaults to 16 kB.
3664
3665 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3666 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3667
3668 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3669 Round Robin.
3670
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003671 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003672 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3673 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3674 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3675
3676 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3677
3678 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003679 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003680 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3681 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3682 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003683
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003684 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003685
3686
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003687bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3688bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003689 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3691 no | yes | yes | no
3692 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003693 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3694 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3695 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3696 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003697 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003698 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3699 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3700 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3701 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3702 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3703 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003704 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003705 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3706 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003707 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003708 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3709 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003710 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003711 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3712 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003713 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003714 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3715 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3716 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3717 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3718 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3719 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3720 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003721 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3722 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3723 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003724 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3725 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3726 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3727 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003728 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3729 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3730 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003731
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003732 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3733 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003734 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3735 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3736 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003737 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3738 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3739 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3740 the range.
3741
3742 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3743 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3744 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3745 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3746 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3747 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3748 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003749 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003750 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003751
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003752 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003753 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003754 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3755 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3756 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3757 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3758 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3759 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3760
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003761 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3762 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3763 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3764 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003765
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003766 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3767 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3768 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3769 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3770 in a frontend.
3771
3772 Example :
3773 listen http_proxy
3774 bind :80,:443
3775 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003776 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003777
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003778 listen http_https_proxy
3779 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003780 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003781
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003782 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3783 bind ipv6@:80
3784 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3785 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3786
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003787 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003788 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003789
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003790 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3791 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3792 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3793 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3794 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3795
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003796 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003797 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003798
3799
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003800bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003801 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3803 yes | yes | yes | yes
3804 Arguments :
3805 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3806 may be used to override a default value.
3807
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003808 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003809 option may be combined with other numbers.
3810
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003811 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003812 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3813 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3814 missing from all processes.
3815
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003816 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003817 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003818 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3819 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3820 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3821 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3822 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003823 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003824
3825 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3826 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3827 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3828 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3829 and 'even' instances.
3830
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003831 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3832 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3833 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3834 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003835
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003836 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3837 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3838
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003839 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3840 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3841 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3842
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003843 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3844 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3845
3846 Example :
3847 listen app_ip1
3848 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003849 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003850
3851 listen app_ip2
3852 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003853 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003854
3855 listen management
3856 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003857 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003858
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003859 listen management
3860 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3861 bind-process 1-4
3862
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003863 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003864
3865
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003866capture cookie <name> len <length>
3867 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3869 no | yes | yes | no
3870 Arguments :
3871 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3872 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3873 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3874 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003875 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003876
3877 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3878 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3879 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3880 right if it exceeds <length>.
3881
3882 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3883 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3884 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3885 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3886
3887 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3888 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3889 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3890
3891 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3892 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3893 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003894 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3895 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3896 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003897
3898 Example:
3899 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3900
3901 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003902 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003903
3904
3905capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003906 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3908 no | yes | yes | no
3909 Arguments :
3910 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003911 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003912 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3913 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3914 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3915
3916 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3917 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3918 it exceeds <length>.
3919
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003920 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003921 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3922 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003923 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3924 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3925 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3926 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003927 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003928 environments to find where the request came from.
3929
3930 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3931 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3932 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3933 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003934
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003935 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3936 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3937 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3938 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3939 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003940
3941 Example:
3942 capture request header Host len 15
3943 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003944 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003945
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003946 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003947 about logging.
3948
3949
3950capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003951 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3953 no | yes | yes | no
3954 Arguments :
3955 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003956 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003957 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3958 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3959 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3960
3961 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3962 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3963 it exceeds <length>.
3964
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003965 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003966 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3967 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3968 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003969 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3970 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3971 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3972 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003973
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003974 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3975 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3976 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3977 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3978 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003979
3980 Example:
3981 capture response header Content-length len 9
3982 capture response header Location len 15
3983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003984 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003985 about logging.
3986
3987
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003988clitcpka-cnt <count>
3989 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3990 the connection on the client side.
3991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3992 yes | yes | yes | no
3993 Arguments :
3994 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3995
3996 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3997 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003998 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3999 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004000
4001 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4002
4003
4004clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4005 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4006 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4007 client side.
4008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4009 yes | yes | yes | no
4010 Arguments :
4011 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4012 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4013 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4014 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4015
4016 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4017 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004018 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4019 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004020
4021 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4022
4023
4024clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4025 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4027 yes | yes | yes | no
4028 Arguments :
4029 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4030 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4031 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4032 document.
4033
4034 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4035 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004036 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4037 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004038
4039 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4040
4041
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004042compression algo <algorithm> ...
4043compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004044compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004045 Enable HTTP compression.
4046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4047 yes | yes | yes | yes
4048 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004049 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4050 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4051 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4052
4053 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004054 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4055 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4056 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004057
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004058 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004059 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004060
4061 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4062 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4063 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4064 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4065 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004066 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004067
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004068 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4069 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4070 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4071 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4072 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4073 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4074 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004075 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004076
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004077 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004078 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004079 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4080 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4081 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4082 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4083 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004084
4085 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4086 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4087 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4088 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4089 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004090 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4091 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4092 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4093 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4094 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004095 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4096 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004097
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004098 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004099 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4100 "Accept-Encoding" header
4101 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004102 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004103 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4104 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4105 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4106 "multipart"
4107 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4108 header
4109 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4110 and later
4111 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4112 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004113 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004114
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004115 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004116
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004117 Examples :
4118 compression algo gzip
4119 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004120
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004121
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004122cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004123 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4124 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004125 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004126 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4128 yes | no | yes | yes
4129 Arguments :
4130 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4131 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4132 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4133 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4134 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4135 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004136 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004137 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4138 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4139
4140 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4141 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4142 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4143 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4144 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4145 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004146 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4147 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004148 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004149 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4150 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004151
4152 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004153 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004154
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004155 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004156 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004157 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004158 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004159 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4160 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4161 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4162 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4163 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4164 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4165 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004166
4167 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4168 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4169 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4170 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4171 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4172 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4173 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4174 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4175 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004176 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004177 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4178 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4179 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004180
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004181 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4182 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4183 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004184 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4185 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4186 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4187 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004188 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4189 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4190 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004191
4192 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4193 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4194 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4195 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4196 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4197 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4198 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4199 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4200 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4201
4202 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4203 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4204 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4205 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4206 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4207 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4208 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4209 persistence cookie in the cache.
4210 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4211
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004212 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4213 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4214 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4215 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4216 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004217 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004218 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4219 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4220 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4221 they logout.
4222
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004223 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4224 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4225 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4226 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4227
4228 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4229 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4230 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4231 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4232 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4233 this attribute.
4234
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004235 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004236 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004237 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4238 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4239 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4240 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4241 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4242 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004243
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004244 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4245 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4246 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4247 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4248 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4249 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4250 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4251 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004252 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004253 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4254 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4255 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4256 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4257 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4258 the site.
4259
4260 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4261 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4262 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4263 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4264 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4265 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4266 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4267 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4268 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4269 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4270 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4271 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4272 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004273 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004274 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4275 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4276
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004277 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4278 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4279 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4280 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4281 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4282 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4283
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004284 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4285 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4286 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4287 repeated.
4288
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004289 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4290 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4291 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4292 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004293
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004294 Examples :
4295 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4296 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4297 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004298 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004299
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004300 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004301
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004302
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004303declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4304 Declares a capture slot.
4305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4306 no | yes | yes | no
4307 Arguments:
4308 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4309
4310 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4311 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4312 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4313 for use in the response.
4314
4315 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004316 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004317 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4318
4319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004320default-server [param*]
4321 Change default options for a server in a backend
4322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4323 yes | no | yes | yes
4324 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004325 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4326 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4327 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4328 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004329
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004330 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004331 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4332
4333 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004334
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004335
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004336default_backend <backend>
4337 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4339 yes | yes | yes | no
4340 Arguments :
4341 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4342
4343 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4344 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4345 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4346 will catch all undetermined requests.
4347
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004348 Example :
4349
4350 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4351 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4352 default_backend dynamic
4353
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004354 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004355
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004356
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004357description <string>
4358 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4360 no | yes | yes | yes
4361 Arguments : string
4362
4363 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4364 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4365 it describes.
4366 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4367
4368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004369disabled
4370 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4372 yes | yes | yes | yes
4373 Arguments : none
4374
4375 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4376 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4377 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4378 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4379 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4380 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4381 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4382
4383 See also : "enabled"
4384
4385
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004386dispatch <address>:<port>
4387 Set a default server address
4388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4389 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004390 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004391
4392 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4393 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4394 during start-up.
4395
4396 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4397 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4398 possible with normal servers.
4399
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004400 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004401 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4402 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4403 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4404 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4405
4406 See also : "server"
4407
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004408
4409dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4410 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4412 yes | no | yes | yes
4413 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4414
4415 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004416 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004417 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4418 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004419 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004420 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004421
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004422enabled
4423 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4425 yes | yes | yes | yes
4426 Arguments : none
4427
4428 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4429 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4430
4431 See also : "disabled"
4432
4433
4434errorfile <code> <file>
4435 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4437 yes | yes | yes | yes
4438 Arguments :
4439 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004440 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004441 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004442
4443 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004444 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004445 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004446 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4447 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004448
4449 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4450 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4451 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4452
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004453 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4454
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004455 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4456 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4457 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4458 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4459 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4460 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4461 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4462 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4463 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004464
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004465 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4466 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4467 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004468 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004469 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4470
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004471 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004472
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004473 Example :
4474 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004475 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004476 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4477 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4478
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004479
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004480errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4481 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4482 section.
4483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4484 yes | yes | yes | yes
4485 Arguments :
4486 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4487
4488 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004489 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004490 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004491
4492 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4493 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4494 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4495 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4496 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004497 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004498 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4499
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004500 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4501 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004502
4503 Example :
4504 errorfiles generic
4505 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4506
4507
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004508errorloc <code> <url>
4509errorloc302 <code> <url>
4510 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4512 yes | yes | yes | yes
4513 Arguments :
4514 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004515 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004516 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004517
4518 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4519 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4520 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4521 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004522 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004523
4524 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4525 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4526 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4527
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004528 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4529
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004530 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4531 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4532 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4533 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004534 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004535 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4536 request.
4537
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004538 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004539
4540
4541errorloc303 <code> <url>
4542 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4544 yes | yes | yes | yes
4545 Arguments :
4546 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004547 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004548 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004549
4550 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4551 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4552 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4553 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004554 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004555
4556 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4557 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4558 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4559
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004560 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4561
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004562 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4563 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4564 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4565 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004566 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004567
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004568 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004569
4570
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004571email-alert from <emailaddr>
4572 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004573 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004574 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4575 yes | yes | yes | yes
4576
4577 Arguments :
4578
4579 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4580
4581 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4582 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4583
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004584 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004585 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4586 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004587
4588
4589email-alert level <level>
4590 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4591 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4592 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4593 yes | yes | yes | yes
4594
4595 Arguments :
4596
4597 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4598 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4599 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4600
4601 By default level is alert
4602
4603 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4604 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4605 for the proxy.
4606
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004607 Alerts are sent when :
4608
4609 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4610 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4611 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4612 is notice or lower
4613 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4614 and a health check status update occurs
4615
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004616 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4617 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004618 section 3.6 about mailers.
4619
4620
4621email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4622 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4623 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4624 yes | yes | yes | yes
4625
4626 Arguments :
4627
4628 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4629
4630 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4631 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4632
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004633 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4634 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004635
4636
4637email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4638 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4639 mailers.
4640 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4641 yes | yes | yes | yes
4642
4643 Arguments :
4644
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004645 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004646
4647 By default the systems hostname is used.
4648
4649 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4650 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4651 for the proxy.
4652
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004653 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4654 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004655
4656
4657email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004658 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004659 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4660 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4661 yes | yes | yes | yes
4662
4663 Arguments :
4664
4665 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4666
4667 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4668 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4669
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004670 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004671 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4672
4673
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004674force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4675 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4676 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004677 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004678
4679 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4680 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4681 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4682 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4683 marked down for maintenance operations.
4684
4685 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4686 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4687 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4688 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4689 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4690 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4691 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4692 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4693 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4694
4695 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4696 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4697 is used.
4698
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004699 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004700 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004701
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004702
4703filter <name> [param*]
4704 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4706 no | yes | yes | yes
4707 Arguments :
4708 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4709 referenced in section 9.
4710
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004711 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004712 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004713 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4714 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004715
4716 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4717 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4718
4719 Example:
4720 listen
4721 bind *:80
4722
4723 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4724 filter compression
4725 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4726
4727 compression algo gzip
4728 compression offload
4729
4730 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4731
4732 See also : section 9.
4733
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004734
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004735fullconn <conns>
4736 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4738 yes | no | yes | yes
4739 Arguments :
4740 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4741 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4742
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004743 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004744 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004745 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004746 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4747 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4748 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4749 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4750 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004751 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004752
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004753 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4754 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004755 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4756 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4757 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004758
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004759 Example :
4760 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4761 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4762 # connections.
4763 backend dynamic
4764 fullconn 10000
4765 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4766 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4767
4768 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4769
4770
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004771grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004772 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004774 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004775 Arguments :
4776 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4777 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4778 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4779
4780 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4781 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004782 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004783 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4784
4785 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4786 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4787 simplify it.
4788
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004789
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004790hash-balance-factor <factor>
4791 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4793 yes | no | no | yes
4794 Arguments :
4795 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4796 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004797 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004798
4799 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4800 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4801 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4802 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4803 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4804 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4805 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4806
4807 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4808 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4809 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4810 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4811 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4812
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004813 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4814 consistent hashing mechanism.
4815
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004816 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4817
4818
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004819hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004820 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4822 yes | no | yes | yes
4823 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004824 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4825 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004826
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004827 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4828 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4829 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4830 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4831 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4832 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4833 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4834 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4835 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4836 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004837
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004838 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4839 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4840 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4841 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4842 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4843 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4844 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4845 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4846 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4847 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4848 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4849 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4850 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004851 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4852 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004853
4854 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4855
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004856 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004857 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4858 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4859 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004860 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4861 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4862 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004863
4864 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4865 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004866 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4867 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4868 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4869 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4870
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004871 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4872 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4873 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4874 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4875 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4876 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4877 parameter.
4878
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004879 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4880 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4881 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4882 used on strings.
4883
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004884 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4885
4886 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4887 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4888 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4889 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4890 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4891 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4892 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4893 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4894 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4895 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4896 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4897 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004898
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004899 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4900 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4901 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004902
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004903 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004904
4905
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004906http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4907 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4908 ones).
4909
4910 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4911 no | yes | yes | yes
4912
4913 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4914 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4915 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4916 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4917 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4918 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4919
4920 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4921 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4922 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4923
4924 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4925 below.
4926
4927 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4928 instance.
4929
4930 Example:
4931 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4932 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4933 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4934
4935http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4936
4937 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4938 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4939 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4940 example, or to pass some internal information.
4941 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4942 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4943 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4944
4945http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4946
4947 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4948 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4949
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004950http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004951
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004952 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
4953 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
4954 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
4955 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
4956 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004957
4958http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4959 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4960
4961 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4962
4963 Example:
4964 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4965
4966 # applied to:
4967 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4968
4969 # outputs:
4970 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4971
4972 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4973
4974http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4975 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4976
4977 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4978
4979 Example:
4980 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4981
4982 # applied to:
4983 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4984
4985 # outputs:
4986 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4987
4988http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4989
4990 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4991 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4992 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4993
4994http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4995 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4996
4997 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4998 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4999 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5000 fallback.
5001
5002 Example:
5003 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5004 http-response set-status 431
5005 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5006 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5007
5008http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5009
5010 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5011 inline.
5012
5013 Arguments:
5014 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5015 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5016 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5017 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5018 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5019 (request and response)
5020 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5021 processing
5022 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5023 processing
5024 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5025 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5026 and '_'.
5027
5028 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5029 followed by some converters.
5030
5031 Example:
5032 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5033
5034http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5035
5036 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5037 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5038 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5039 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5040 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005041 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005042 processing.
5043
5044 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5045 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005046 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005047 rules evaluation.
5048
5049http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5050
5051 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5052 details about <var-name>.
5053
5054 Example:
5055 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5056
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005057
5058http-check comment <string>
5059 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5060 it fails.
5061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5062 yes | no | yes | yes
5063
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005064 Arguments :
5065 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5066 rule fails.
5067
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005068 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5069 user-friendly error reporting.
5070
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005071 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005072 "http-check expect".
5073
5074
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005075http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5076 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005077 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005078 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5080 yes | no | yes | yes
5081
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005082 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005083 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5084
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005085 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005086 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005087
5088 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5089 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5090 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5091 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5092
5093 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5094
5095 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5096
5097 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5098
5099 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5100
5101 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5102
5103 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5104 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5105 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5106 is used.
5107
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005108 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5109 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5110 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5111 haproxy -vv.
5112
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005113 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5114
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005115 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5116 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5117 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5118 different ports or with different servers.
5119
5120 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5121 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5122 the port with a "http-check connect".
5123
5124 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5125 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5126 do.
5127
5128 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5129 unset-var or comment rules.
5130
5131 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005132 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5133 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5134 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5135 option httpchk
5136
5137 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005138 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005139 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005140 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005141 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005142 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005143
5144 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5145
5146 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005147
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005148
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005149http-check disable-on-404
5150 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005152 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005153 Arguments : none
5154
5155 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5156 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5157 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5158 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5159 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5160 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5161 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5162 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005163 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5164 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005165 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5166 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5167 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005168
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005169 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005170
5171
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005172http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005173 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5174 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5175 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005176 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005178 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005179
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005180 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005181 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5182
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005183 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5184 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5185 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5186 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5187 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5188 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5189 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5190 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5191 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5192 result is always conclusive.
5193
5194 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5195 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5196 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005197 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5198 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005199 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5200 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005201 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5202 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5203 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005204
5205 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5206 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005207 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5208 supported :
5209 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5210 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005211 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5212 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5213 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5214 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5215 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005216
5217 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5218 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005219 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5220 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5221 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5222 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005223 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5224
5225 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5226 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5227 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5228 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5229
5230 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5231 informational message reported in logs if an error
5232 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5233 log-format string.
5234
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005235 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005236 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5237 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005238 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5239 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5240 details on the supported keywords.
5241
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005242 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5243 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5244 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5245 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005246
5247 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5248 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5249 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5250 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5251 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5252
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005253 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5254 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5255 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5256 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5257 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5258 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5259 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005260
5261 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005262 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005263 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5264 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5265 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5266 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5267
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005268 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5269 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005270 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5271 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5272 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5273 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5274 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5275 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5276 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5277 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005278 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5279 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5280 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5281 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5282 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5283 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5284 insensitive on the header names.
5285
5286 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5287 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5288 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5289 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5290 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5291 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005292
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005293 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005294 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005295 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5296 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5297 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5298 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5299 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005300 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005301 trace).
5302
5303 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005304 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005305 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5306 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5307 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5308 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5309 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005310 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005311
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005312 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5313 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5314 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5315 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5316 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5317 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5318
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005319 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005320 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005321 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5322 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5323 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5324 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5325 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5326 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5327
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005328 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5329 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5330 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5331 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5332 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005333
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005334 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5335 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5336
5337 Examples :
5338 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005339 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005340
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005341 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5342 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5343
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005344 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005345 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005346
5347 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005348 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005349
5350 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005351 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005352
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005353 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005354 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005355
5356
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005357http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005358 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5359 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005360 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5361 health checks.
5362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5363 yes | no | yes | yes
5364 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005365 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5366
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005367 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5368 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5369 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5370 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5371 to invent non-standard ones.
5372
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005373 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5374 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5375 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5376 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5377
5378 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5379 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5380 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5381 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005382
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005383 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005384 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005385 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005386 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5387 to add it.
5388
5389 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5390 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5391 to the log-format rules.
5392
5393 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5394 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5395 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005396
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005397 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5398 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5399 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5400 request.
5401
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005402 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5403 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5404 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005405 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5406 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5407 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5408 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005409 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005410 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005411 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
5412
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005413 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
5414 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005415 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5416 so, it will be ignored.
5417
5418 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5419 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5420 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5421 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5422 configured request authority.
5423
5424 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5425 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005426
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005427 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005428
5429
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005430http-check send-state
5431 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5433 yes | no | yes | yes
5434 Arguments : none
5435
5436 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5437 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5438 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5439 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5440 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5441
5442 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5443 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5444 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5445 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5446 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005447 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5448 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5449 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5450
5451 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5452 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5453 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5454
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005455 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5456 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5457 checked in multiple backends.
5458
5459 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5460 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5461
5462 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5463 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5464 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5465 one fails.
5466
5467 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5468 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5469 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5470
5471 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5472 server's queue.
5473
5474 Example of a header received by the application server :
5475 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5476 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5477
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005478 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5479 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005480
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005481
5482http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005483 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005484 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5485 yes | no | yes | yes
5486
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005487 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005488 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5489 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5490 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5491 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5492 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5493 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5494 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5495 and '-'.
5496
5497 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5498
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005499 Examples :
5500 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005501
5502
5503http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005504 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005505 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5506 yes | no | yes | yes
5507
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005508 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005509 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5510 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5511 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5512 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5513 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5514 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5515 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5516 and '-'.
5517
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005518 Examples :
5519 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005520
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005521
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005522http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5523 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5524 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5525 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5526 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5528 yes | yes | yes | yes
5529 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005530 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005531 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005532 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5533 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005534
5535 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5536 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5537 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5538 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5539
5540 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5541 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5542 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5543 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5544
5545 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5546 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5547 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5548 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5549 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5550 chroot is performed.
5551
5552 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5553 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5554 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5555 considered.
5556
5557 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5558 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5559 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5560 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5561 considered as a raw string.
5562
5563 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5564 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5565 "content-type".
5566
5567 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5568 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5569 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5570 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5571 evaluated as a log-format string.
5572
5573 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5574 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5575 argument to "content-type".
5576
5577 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5578 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5579 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5580 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5581
5582 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5583 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5584 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5585 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5586 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5587 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5588 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5589 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5590
5591 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5592 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5593 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5594
5595 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5596 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5597
5598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005599http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005600 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5601
5602 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5603 no | yes | yes | yes
5604
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005605 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5606 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5607 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5608 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5609 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005611 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5612 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005614 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005616 Example:
5617 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5618 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5619 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005621 http-request allow if nagios
5622 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5623 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5624 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005626 Example:
5627 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5628 acl add path /addacl
5629 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005631 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005632
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005633 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5634 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005635
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005636 Example:
5637 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5638 acl setmap path /setmap
5639 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005641 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005643 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5644 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005646 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5647 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005649http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005650
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005651 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5652 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5653 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5654 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5655 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5656 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5657 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5658 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005659
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005660http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005662 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5663 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5664 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5665 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5666 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5667 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5668 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5669 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005671http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005672
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005673 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5674 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005675
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005676
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005677http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005678
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005679 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5680 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5681 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5682 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5683 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005684
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005685 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5686 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5687 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5688 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5689 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5690 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5691 instead.
5692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005693 Example:
5694 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5695 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005696
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005697http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005698
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005699 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005700
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005701http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5702 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005703
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005704 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5705 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5706 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5707 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5708 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5709 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5710 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5711 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5712 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005713
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005714 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5715 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5716 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005717 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5718
5719 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5720 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5721 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5722 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005723
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005724http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005725
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005726 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5727 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5728 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5729 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5730 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5731 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005732
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005733http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005734
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005735 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5736 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5737 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5738 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5739 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005740
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005741http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005742
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005743 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5744 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5745 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5746 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5747 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5748 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005749
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005750http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5751http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5752 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5753 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5754 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5755 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005756
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005757 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5758 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5759 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005760 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005761 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5762 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5763 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005764 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005765 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005766
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005767http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5768 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5769 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5770 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5771
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005772http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5773
5774 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5775 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5776 pointed by <resolvers>.
5777 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5778 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5779 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5780 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5781 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5782 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5783 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5784 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5785 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5786 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5787 to 0.0.0.0.
5788
5789 Example:
5790 resolvers mydns
5791 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5792 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5793 timeout retry 1s
5794 hold valid 10s
5795 hold nx 3s
5796 hold other 3s
5797 hold obsolete 0s
5798 accepted_payload_size 8192
5799
5800 frontend fe
5801 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5802 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5803 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5804
5805 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5806 # which mean DNS resolution error
5807 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5808
5809 default_backend be
5810
5811 backend b_503
5812 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5813 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5814 # 503 error page to end users
5815
5816 backend be
5817 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5818 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5819 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5820 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5821 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5822
5823 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5824 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5825
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005826http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5827
5828 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5829 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5830 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5831 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005832 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5833 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005834
5835 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5836
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005837http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005838
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005839 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5840 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5841 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5842 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5843 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005844
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005845http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005846
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005847 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5848 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5849 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5850 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005851
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005852http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5853 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005854
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005855 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005856 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5857 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5858 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5859 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5860 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005861
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005862 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5863 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5864 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5865 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5866 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005867
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005868 Example:
5869 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5870
5871 # applied to:
5872 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5873
5874 # outputs:
5875 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5876
5877 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005878
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005879 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5880
5881 # applied to:
5882 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005883
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005884 # outputs:
5885 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005886
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005887http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5888 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5889
5890 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5891 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005892 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5893 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5894 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005895
5896 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5897 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5898 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5899
5900 Example:
5901 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5902 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5903
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005904 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5905 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5906 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5907 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5908
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005909http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5910 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5911
5912 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5913 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5914 query-string are replaced.
5915
5916 Example:
5917 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5918 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5919
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005920http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5921 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5922
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005923 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5924 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5925 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5926 against.
5927
5928 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5929 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5930 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005931
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005932 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5933 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5934 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5935 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5936 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5937 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5938 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5939 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5940 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005941 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5942 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005943
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005944 Example:
5945 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5946 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005947
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005948 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5949 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005950
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005951http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5952 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005953
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005954 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5955 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5956 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5957 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005958
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005959 Example:
5960 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005961
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005962 # applied to:
5963 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005964
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005965 # outputs:
5966 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005967
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005968http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5969 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5970 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005971 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005972 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5973
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005974 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005975 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5976 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005977 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005978 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005979 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005980 are followed to create the response :
5981
5982 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5983 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5984 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5985 ignored.
5986
5987 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5988 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005989 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005990 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5991 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005992
5993 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5994 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5995 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005996 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005997 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005998
5999 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6000 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6001 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006002 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006003 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6004 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006005
6006 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6007 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6008 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6009 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6010 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6011 as a raw content.
6012
6013 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6014 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6015 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6016 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6017 considered as a raw string.
6018
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006019 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006020 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6021 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6022 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6023
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006024 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6025 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006026 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006027
6028 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6029
6030 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006031 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006032 if { path /ping }
6033
6034 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6035 if { path /favicon.ico }
6036
6037 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6038 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6039 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6040
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006041http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6042http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006043
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006044 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6045 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6046 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006047
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006048http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6049 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006050
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006051 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6052 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6053 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6054 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006056http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006057
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006058 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6059 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6060 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6061 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6062 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006063
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006064 Arguments:
6065 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6066 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006067
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006068 Example:
6069 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6070 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006072 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6073 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006074
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006075http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006076
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006077 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6078 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6079 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006081 Arguments:
6082 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6083 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006084
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006085 Example:
6086 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6087 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006088
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006089 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6090 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6091 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006092
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006093http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006094
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006095 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6096 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6097 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6098 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6099 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006100
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006101 Example:
6102 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6103 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6104 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6105 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6106 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6107 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6108 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6109 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6110 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006112http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006113
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006114 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6115 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6116 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6117 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6118 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006119
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006120http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6121 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006123 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6124 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6125 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6126 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6127 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6128 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6129 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6130 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6131 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006132
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006133http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006134
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006135 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6136 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6137 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6138 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6139 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6140 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6141 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006142
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006143http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006145 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6146 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6147 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006148
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006149http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006150
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006151 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6152 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6153 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6154 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6155 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6156 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6157 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6158 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006159
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006160http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006161
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006162 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6163 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6164 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6165 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6166 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6167 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006168
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006169 Example :
6170 # prepend the host name before the path
6171 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006172
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006173http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6174
6175 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6176 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6177 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006179http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006180
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006181 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6182 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6183 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6184 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6185 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006186
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006187http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006189 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6190 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6191 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6192 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6193 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6194 values have higher priority.
6195 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6196 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6197 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6198 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6199 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006200
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006201http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006202
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006203 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6204 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6205 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6206 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6207 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6208 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6209 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006210
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006211 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006212
6213 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006214 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6215 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006216
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006217http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6218 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6219 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6220 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006221 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6222 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006223
6224 Arguments :
6225 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6226 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006227
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006228 See also "option forwardfor".
6229
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006230 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006231 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6232 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6233
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006234 # After the masking this will track connections
6235 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6236 http-request track-sc0 src
6237
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006238 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6239 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6240
6241http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6242
6243 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6244 expression.
6245
6246 Arguments:
6247 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6248 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006249
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006250 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006251 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6252 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6253
6254 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6255 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6256 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6257
6258http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6259
6260 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6261 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6262 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6263 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6264 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6265 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6266 information from the request.
6267
6268 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6269
6270http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6271
6272 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6273 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6274 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6275 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6276 path and the query string.
6277 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6278
6279http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6280
6281 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6282 inline.
6283
6284 Arguments:
6285 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6286 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6287 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6288 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6289 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6290 (request and response)
6291 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6292 processing
6293 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6294 processing
6295 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6296 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6297 and '_'.
6298
6299 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6300 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006301
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006302 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006303 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006304
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006305http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6306 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006307
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006308 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6309 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6310 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6311 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6312 agent name must be used.
6313
6314 Arguments:
6315 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6316
6317 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6318 configuration.
6319
6320http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6321
6322 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6323 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6324 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6325 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6326 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6327 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6328 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6329 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6330 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6331 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6332 action.
6333 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6334 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6335 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6336 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6337 you fully understand how it works.
6338
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006339http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6340
6341 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6342 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6343 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6344 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6345 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006346 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006347 processing.
6348
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006349 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006350 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6351 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6352 rules evaluation.
6353
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006354http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6355http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6356 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6357 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6358 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6359 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006360
6361 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6362 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6363 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006364 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6365 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6366 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6367 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6368 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6369 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6370 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6371 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6372 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6373 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006374 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006375 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6376 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6377 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6378 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6379 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006380
6381http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6382http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6383http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6384
6385 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6386 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6387 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6388 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006389 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006390 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6391 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6392 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6393 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6394 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6395 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6396 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6397
6398 Arguments :
6399 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6400 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6401 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6402 select which table entry to update the counters.
6403
6404 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6405 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6406 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6407 that table until the session ends.
6408
6409 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6410 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6411 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6412 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6413 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6414 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6415 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6416 useful information.
6417
6418 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6419 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6420 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6421 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6422 checks that make use of it.
6423
6424http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6425
6426 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006427
6428 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006429 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006430
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006431http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6432
6433 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6434 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6435 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6436 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6437 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6438 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6439
6440 Arguments :
6441 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6442
6443 Example:
6444 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6445
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006446http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006447
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006448 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6449 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6450 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006451
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006452
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006453http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006454 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6455
6456 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6457 no | yes | yes | yes
6458
6459 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6460 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6461 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6462 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6463 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6464 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6465
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006466 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6467 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006468
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006469 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006470
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006471 Example:
6472 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006473
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006474 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006475
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006476 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6477 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006478
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006479 Example:
6480 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006481
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006482 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006483
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006484 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6485 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006486
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006487 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6488 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006489
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006490http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006491
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006492 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6493 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6494 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6495 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6496 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6497 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6498 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6499 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006500
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006501http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006502
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006503 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6504 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6505 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6506 example, or to pass some internal information.
6507 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6508 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6509 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006510
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006511http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006512
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006513 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6514 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006515
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006516http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006517
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006518 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006519
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006520http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006521
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006522 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6523 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6524 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6525 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6526 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6527 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6528 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006529
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006530 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6531 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6532 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6533 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6534 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006535
6536 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6537 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6538 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6539 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006540
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006541http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006542
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006543 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6544 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6545 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6546 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6547 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6548 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006549
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006550http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006551
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006552 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6553 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6554 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6555 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6556 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006557
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006558http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006559
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006560 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6561 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6562 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6563 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6564 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6565 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006566
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006567http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6568http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6569 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6570 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6571 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6572 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006573
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006574 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6575 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6576 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006577 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006578 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6579 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6580 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006581 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006582 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006583
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006584http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006585
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006586 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6587 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6588 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6589 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6590 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6591 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006592
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006593http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6594 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006595
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006596 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6597 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006598
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006599 Example:
6600 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006601
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006602 # applied to:
6603 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006604
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006605 # outputs:
6606 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006607
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006608 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006609
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006610http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6611 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006612
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006613 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006614 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006615
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006616 Example:
6617 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006618
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006619 # applied to:
6620 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006621
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006622 # outputs:
6623 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006624
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006625http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6626 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6627 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006628 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006629 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6630
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006631 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006632 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6633 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006634 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006635 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006636 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006637 are followed to create the response :
6638
6639 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6640 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6641 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6642 ignored.
6643
6644 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6645 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006646 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006647 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6648 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006649
6650 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6651 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6652 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006653 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006654 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006655
6656 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6657 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6658 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006659 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006660 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6661 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006662
6663 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6664 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6665 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6666 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6667 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6668 as a raw content.
6669
6670 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6671 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6672 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6673 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6674 considered as a raw string.
6675
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006676 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6677 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6678 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6679 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6680
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006681 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6682 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006683 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006684
6685 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6686
6687 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006688 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006689 if { status eq 404 }
6690
6691 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6692 string "This is the end !" \
6693 if { status eq 500 }
6694
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006695http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6696http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006697
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006698 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6699 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6700 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006701
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006702http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6703 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006704
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006705 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6706 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6707 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6708 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006709
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006710http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006711
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006712 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6713 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6714 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6715 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6716 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006717
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006718 Arguments:
6719 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006720
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006721 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6722 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006723
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006724http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006725
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006726 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6727 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6728 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006729
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006730http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6731
6732 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6733 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6734 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6735 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6736 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6737
6738http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6739
6740 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6741 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6742 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6743 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6744 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6745 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6746 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6747 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6748 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6749
6750http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6751
6752 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6753 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6754 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6755 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6756 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6757 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6758 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6759
6760http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6761
6762 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6763 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6764 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6765 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6766 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6767 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6768 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6769 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6770
6771http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6772 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6773
6774 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6775 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6776 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6777 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006778
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006779 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006780 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6781 http-response set-status 431
6782 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6783 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006784
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006785http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006786
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006787 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6788 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6789 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6790 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6791 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6792 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6793 based on some information from the request.
6794
6795 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6796
6797http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6798
6799 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6800 inline.
6801
6802 Arguments:
6803 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6804 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6805 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6806 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6807 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6808 (request and response)
6809 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6810 processing
6811 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6812 processing
6813 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6814 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6815 and '_'.
6816
6817 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6818 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006819
6820 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006821 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006822
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006823http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006824
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006825 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6826 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6827 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6828 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6829 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6830 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6831 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6832 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6833 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6834 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6835 action.
6836 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6837 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6838 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6839 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6840 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006841
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006842http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6843
6844 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6845 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6846 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6847 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6848 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006849 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006850 processing.
6851
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006852 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006853 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006854 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006855 rules evaluation.
6856
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006857http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6858http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6859http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006860
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006861 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6862 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6863 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6864 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6865 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6866 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6867
6868http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6869
6870 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6871 about <var-name>.
6872
6873 Example:
6874 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6875
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006876
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006877http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6878 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6879
6880 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6881 yes | no | yes | yes
6882
6883 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006884 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6885 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6886 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006887
6888 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6889
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006890 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6891 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6892 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6893 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6894 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6895 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6896 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6897 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6898 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6899 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006900
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006901 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6902 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6903 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6904 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6905 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6906 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6907 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02006908 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
6909 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
6910 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
6911 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
6912 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
6913 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006914
6915 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6916 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6917 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6918 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6919 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6920 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6921 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6922 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006923 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006924 downsides of rare connection failures.
6925
6926 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6927 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6928 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6929 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6930 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6931 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006932 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006933 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6934 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6935 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6936 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6937 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6938
6939 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006940 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6941 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6942 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006943
Amaury Denoyelle7239c242020-10-15 16:41:09 +02006944 - connections sent to a server with a variable value as TLS SNI extension
6945 are marked private and are never shared. This is not the case if the SNI
6946 is guaranteed to be a constant, as for example using a literal string;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006947
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006948 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6949 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006950
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006951 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006952
6953 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6954 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6955 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6956
6957 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6958
6959
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006960http-send-name-header [<header>]
6961 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006962 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6963 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006964 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006965 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6966
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006967 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6968 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6969 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6970 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6971 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6972 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6973 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6974 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6975 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6976 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6977 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6978 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6979 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6980 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6981 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6982 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006983
6984 See also : "server"
6985
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006986id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006987 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6989 no | yes | yes | yes
6990 Arguments : none
6991
6992 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6993 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6994 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006995
6996
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006997ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6998 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6999 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007000 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007001
7002 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7003 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7004 and running).
7005
7006 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7007 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7008 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007009 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007010 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7011
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007012 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7013 "unless" condition is met.
7014
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007015 Example:
7016 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7017 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7018 ignore-persist if url_static
7019
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007020 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7021
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007022load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7023 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7024 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7025 yes | no | yes | yes
7026
7027 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7028 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7029 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007030 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007031 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7032 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7033 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7034 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7035
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007036 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007037 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007038 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007039
7040 Arguments:
7041 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7042 named "server-state-file".
7043
7044 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7045 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7046 name is used as a file name.
7047
7048 none don't load any stat for this backend
7049
7050 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007051 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7052 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7053 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007054 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007055 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007056
7057 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7058 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7059
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007060 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007061
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007062 global
7063 stats socket /tmp/socket
7064 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007065
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007066 defaults
7067 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007068
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007069 backend bk
7070 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7071 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007072
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007073
7074 Then one can run :
7075
7076 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7077
7078 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7079
7080 1
7081 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7082 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7083 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7084
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007085 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007086
7087 global
7088 stats socket /tmp/socket
7089 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7090
7091 defaults
7092 load-server-state-from-file local
7093
7094 backend bk
7095 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7096 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7097
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007098
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007099 Then one can run :
7100
7101 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7102
7103 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7104
7105 1
7106 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7107 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7108 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7109
7110 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7111 "show servers state"
7112
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007113
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007114log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007115log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
7116 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007117no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007118 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7120 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007121
7122 Prefix :
7123 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7124 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7125 prefix does not allow arguments.
7126
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007127 Arguments :
7128 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7129 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7130 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7131 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7132 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7133 parameter.
7134
7135 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7136 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7137
7138 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7139 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7140 standard syslog port).
7141
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007142 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7143 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7144 standard syslog port).
7145
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007146 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7147 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7148 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007149 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007150
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007151 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7152 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7153 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7154 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7155 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7156 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7157 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7158 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7159 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7160 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7161 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7162 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7163 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7164 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7165 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7166 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007167 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7168 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007169
7170 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7171 and "fd@2", see above.
7172
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007173 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7174 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7175 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7176 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7177 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7178 having the logs instantly available.
7179
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007180 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7181 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007182
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007183 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7184 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7185 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7186 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7187 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7188 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7189 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7190 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7191 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7192 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007193 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007194
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007195 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7196 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7197 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7198 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7199 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7200
7201 <sample_size>
7202 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7203 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7204 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7205 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7206 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7207
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007208 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7209 one of the following :
7210
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007211 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7212 field is stripped. This is the default.
7213 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7214 rfc3164.
7215
7216 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007217 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7218
7219 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7220 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7221
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007222 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7223 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7224 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7225 designed to be used with a local log server.
7226
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007227 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7228 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7229 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7230 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7231 systemd logger consumes.
7232
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007233 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7234 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7235 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7236 used with a local log server.
7237
7238 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7239 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7240 designed to be used with a local log server.
7241
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007242 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7243 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7244 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7245 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7246
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007247 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7248
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007249 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7250 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7251 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7252
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007253 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7254 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7255 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7256 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007257
7258 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7259 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7260 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007261 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7262 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7263 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7264 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7265 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007266
7267 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7268
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007269 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7270 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7271 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007272
7273 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7274 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7275 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7276 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7277
7278 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7279 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007280
7281 Example :
7282 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007283 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7284 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7285 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007286 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7287 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007288 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007289
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007290
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007291log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007292 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7293 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7294 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007295
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007296 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7297 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7298 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7299 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7300 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007301
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007302 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7303 "option httplog" directives.
7304
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007305log-format-sd <string>
7306 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7307 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7308 yes | yes | yes | no
7309
7310 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7311 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7312 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7313 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7314 which covers the log format string in depth.
7315
7316 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7317 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7318
7319 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7320 log format to "rfc5424".
7321
7322 Example :
7323 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7324
7325
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007326log-tag <string>
7327 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7328 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7329 yes | yes | yes | yes
7330
7331 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7332 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7333 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7334 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7335 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7336 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7337 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7338 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7339 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007340
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007341max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7342 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7343 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7344 yes | no | yes | yes
7345
7346 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7347 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7348 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7349 servers.
7350
7351 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7352 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7353 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7354 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7355 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007356 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007357 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7358 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7359 picking a different server.
7360
7361 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7362 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7363 even if they have to be queued.
7364
7365 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7366 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7367
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007368max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7369 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7370 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7371 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007372
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007373maxconn <conns>
7374 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7376 yes | yes | yes | no
7377 Arguments :
7378 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7379 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7380 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7381 closes.
7382
7383 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7384 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7385 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7386 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007387 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7388 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7389 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7390 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007391
7392 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7393 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7394 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7395
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007396 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7397 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007398
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007399 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7400
7401
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007402mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007403 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7405 yes | yes | yes | yes
7406 Arguments :
7407 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7408 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7409 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7410 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7411
7412 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7413 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7414 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7415 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7416 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7417
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007418 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7419 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7420 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007421
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007422 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007423 defaults http_instances
7424 mode http
7425
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007426
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007427monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007428 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7430 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007431 Arguments :
7432 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7433 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007434 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007435 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7436 backend and its backup.
7437
7438 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7439 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7440 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7441 servers in a list of backends.
7442
7443 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7444 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7445 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7446 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7447 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7448 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7449 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007450 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7451 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007452
7453 Example:
7454 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007455 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007456 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7457 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7458 monitor-uri /site_alive
7459 monitor fail if site_dead
7460
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007461 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007462
7463
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007464monitor-uri <uri>
7465 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7467 yes | yes | yes | no
7468 Arguments :
7469 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7470 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7471
7472 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7473 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7474 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7475 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7476 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7477 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7478 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7479 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7480
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007481 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007482 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7483 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7484 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7485 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7486 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7487 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007488
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007489 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7490 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7491 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7492 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7493
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007494 Example :
7495 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7496 frontend www
7497 mode http
7498 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7499
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007500 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007501
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007502
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007503option abortonclose
7504no option abortonclose
7505 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7507 yes | no | yes | yes
7508 Arguments : none
7509
7510 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7511 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7512 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7513 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007514 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007515 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7516 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7517 encountered while delivering the response.
7518
7519 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7520 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7521 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7522 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7523 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7524 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007525 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007526 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007527 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007528 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7529 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7530 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7531
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007532 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7533 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007534 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7535 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7536 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7537 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7538 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7539 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007540 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007541
7542 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7543 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7544
7545 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7546
7547
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007548option accept-invalid-http-request
7549no option accept-invalid-http-request
7550 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7552 yes | yes | yes | no
7553 Arguments : none
7554
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007555 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007556 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007557 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007558 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7559 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7560 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7561 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7562 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007563 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7564 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7565 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7566 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007567 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007568 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007569 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7570 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7571 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007572
7573 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7574 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7575 been confirmed.
7576
7577 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7578 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007579 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7580 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007581 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7582
7583 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7584 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7585
7586 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7587 stats socket.
7588
7589
7590option accept-invalid-http-response
7591no option accept-invalid-http-response
7592 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7594 yes | no | yes | yes
7595 Arguments : none
7596
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007597 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007598 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007599 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007600 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7601 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7602 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7603 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7604 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007605 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7606 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7607 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007608
7609 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7610 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7611 been confirmed.
7612
7613 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7614 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7615 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7616 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7617
7618 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7619 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7620
7621 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7622 stats socket.
7623
7624
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007625option allbackups
7626no option allbackups
7627 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7629 yes | no | yes | yes
7630 Arguments : none
7631
7632 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7633 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7634 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7635 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7636 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7637 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7638 order between the backup servers anymore.
7639
7640 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7641 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7642
7643 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7644 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7645
7646
7647option checkcache
7648no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007649 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7651 yes | no | yes | yes
7652 Arguments : none
7653
7654 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7655 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007656 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007657 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7658 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007659 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007660
7661 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007662 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007663 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007664 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7665 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007666 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007667 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007668 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7669 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007670 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007671 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7672 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007673 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007674 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7675 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7676 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7677 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7678 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7679 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7680 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7681 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7682 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7683
7684 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007685 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7686 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7687 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7688 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007689
7690 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7691 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007692 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007693 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007694
7695 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7696 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7697
7698
7699option clitcpka
7700no option clitcpka
7701 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7703 yes | yes | yes | no
7704 Arguments : none
7705
7706 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7707 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007708 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007709 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7710
7711 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7712 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7713 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7714 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7715
7716 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7717 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7718 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7719 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7720 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7721
7722 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7723
7724 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7725 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7726 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7727
7728 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7729 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7730
7731 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7732
7733
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007734option contstats
7735 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7737 yes | yes | yes | no
7738 Arguments : none
7739
7740 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7741 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7742 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7743 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007744 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7745 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7746 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7747 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7748 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007749
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007750option disable-h2-upgrade
7751no option disable-h2-upgrade
7752 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7753 connection.
7754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7755 yes | yes | yes | no
7756 Arguments : none
7757
7758 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7759 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7760 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7761 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7762 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7763 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7764 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7765 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7766
7767 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7768 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007769
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007770option dontlog-normal
7771no option dontlog-normal
7772 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7774 yes | yes | yes | no
7775 Arguments : none
7776
7777 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7778 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7779 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7780 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7781 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7782 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7783 logged.
7784
7785 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7786 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7787 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007789 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007790 logging.
7791
7792
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007793option dontlognull
7794no option dontlognull
7795 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7797 yes | yes | yes | no
7798 Arguments : none
7799
7800 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7801 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7802 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7803 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7804 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7805 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007806 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7807 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7808 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007809
7810 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007811 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007812 would not be logged.
7813
7814 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7815 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7816
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007817 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007818 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007819
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007820
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007821option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007822 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7824 yes | yes | yes | yes
7825 Arguments :
7826 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7827 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007828 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007829 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007830
7831 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7832 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7833 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7834 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7835 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7836 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7837 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007838 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7839 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7840 possible that the client has already brought one.
7841
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007842 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007843 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007844 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007845 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007846 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007847 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007848
7849 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7850 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7851 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7852 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7853 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7854 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7855 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7856
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007857 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7858 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7859 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7860 are under the control of the end-user.
7861
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007862 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007863 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7864 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007865 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7866 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7867 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007868
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007869 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007870 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7871 frontend www
7872 mode http
7873 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7874
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007875 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7876 backend www
7877 mode http
7878 option forwardfor header X-Client
7879
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007880 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007881 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007882
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007883
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007884option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7885no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7886 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7888 yes | yes | yes | no
7889 Arguments : none
7890
7891 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7892 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7893 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7894 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7895 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7896 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7897 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7898
7899 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7900 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7901 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7902 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7903 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7904 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7905 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7906 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7907 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7908 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7909
7910 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7911
7912 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7913 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7914
7915 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7916 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7917
7918
7919option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7920no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7921 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7923 yes | no | yes | yes
7924 Arguments : none
7925
7926 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7927 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7928 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7929 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7930 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7931 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7932 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7933
7934 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7935 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7936 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7937 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7938 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7939 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7940 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7941 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7942 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7943 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7944
7945 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7946
7947 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7948 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7949
7950 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7951 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7952
7953
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007954option http-buffer-request
7955no option http-buffer-request
7956 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7958 yes | yes | yes | yes
7959 Arguments : none
7960
7961 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7962 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7963 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7964 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7965 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7966 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007967 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7968 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7969 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7970 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007971
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007972 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007973
7974
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007975option http-ignore-probes
7976no option http-ignore-probes
7977 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7979 yes | yes | yes | no
7980 Arguments : none
7981
7982 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7983 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7984 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7985 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7986 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7987 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7988 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7989 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7990 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007991 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7992 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007993 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7994
7995 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7996 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7997 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7998 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7999 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8000 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8001 are often the only way to detect them.
8002
8003 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8004 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8005
8006 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8007
8008
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008009option http-keep-alive
8010no option http-keep-alive
8011 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8013 yes | yes | yes | yes
8014 Arguments : none
8015
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008016 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8017 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008018 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8019 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008020 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8021 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8022 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008023
8024 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8025 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008026 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8027 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8028 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8029 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8030 situations where this option may be useful :
8031
8032 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008033 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008034
8035 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8036 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8037
8038 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8039 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8040 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8041 request.
8042
8043 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8044 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008045 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8046 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8047 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008048
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008049 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8050 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8051 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8052 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8053 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8054 not set.
8055
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008056 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8057 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8058 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008059
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008060 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008061 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008062 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008063
8064
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008065option http-no-delay
8066no option http-no-delay
8067 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8069 yes | yes | yes | yes
8070 Arguments : none
8071
8072 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8073 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8074 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8075 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8076 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8077 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8078 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8079 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8080 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8081 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8082 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8083 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8084 affected.
8085
8086 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8087 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8088 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8089 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8090 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8091 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8092 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8093 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8094 latency environments.
8095
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008096 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8097
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008098
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008099option http-pretend-keepalive
8100no option http-pretend-keepalive
8101 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008103 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008104 Arguments : none
8105
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008106 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008107 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8108 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8109 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8110 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8111 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8112 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8113 consider the response complete.
8114
8115 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8116 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8117 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8118 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008119 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008120 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8121
8122 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8123 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8124 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8125 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8126 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8127 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8128 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8129
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008130 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8131 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8132 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8133 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8134 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8135 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008136
8137 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8138 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8139
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008140 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008141 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008142
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008143
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008144option http-server-close
8145no option http-server-close
8146 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8148 yes | yes | yes | yes
8149 Arguments : none
8150
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008151 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8152 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8153 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8154 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008155 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8156 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8157 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8158 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8159 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8160 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8161 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8162 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8163 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8164 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8165 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008166
8167 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8168 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8169 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8170 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008171 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8172 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008173
8174 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8175 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008176 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8177 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8178 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008179
8180 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8181 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8182
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008183 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8184 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008185
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008186option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008187no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008188 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8190 yes | yes | yes | no
8191 Arguments : none
8192
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008193 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008194 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8195 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8196 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8197 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8198 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8199 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8200
8201 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8202 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008203 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8204 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8205 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008206
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008207 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8208 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8209 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8210 front of an existing proxy.
8211
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008212 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8213
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008214 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008215
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008216option httpchk
8217option httpchk <uri>
8218option httpchk <method> <uri>
8219option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008220 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8222 yes | no | yes | yes
8223 Arguments :
8224 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8225 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8226 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8227 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8228 ones.
8229
8230 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8231 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8232 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8233
8234 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8235 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8236 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008237 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008238
8239 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8240 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8241 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8242 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8243 the lack of any response.
8244
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008245 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8246 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8247 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8248 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8249
8250 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8251 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8252 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008253
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008254 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8255 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008256 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008257 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008258 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008259
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008260 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8261 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8262 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8263 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8264
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008265 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008266 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8267 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8268 backend https_relay
8269 mode tcp
8270 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8271 http-check send hdr Host www
8272 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008273
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008274 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8275 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8276 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008277
8278
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008279option httpclose
8280no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008281 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8283 yes | yes | yes | yes
8284 Arguments : none
8285
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008286 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8287 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8288 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8289 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008290 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008291
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008292 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8293 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008294 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008295 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8296 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008297
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008298 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8299 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8300 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008301
8302 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8303 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008304 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8305 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8306 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008307
8308 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8309 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8310
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008311 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008312
8313
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008314option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008315 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008317 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008318 Arguments :
8319 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8320 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8321 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008322 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008323 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008324
8325 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8326 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8327 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8328 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8329 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8330 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8331 ports.
8332
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008333 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8334 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008335
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008336 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008338 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008339
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008340
8341option http_proxy
8342no option http_proxy
8343 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8345 yes | yes | yes | yes
8346 Arguments : none
8347
8348 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8349 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8350 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8351 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8352 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8353
8354 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8355 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008356 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8357 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008358
8359 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8360 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8361
8362 Example :
8363 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8364 backend direct_forward
8365 option httpclose
8366 option http_proxy
8367
8368 See also : "option httpclose"
8369
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008370
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008371option independent-streams
8372no option independent-streams
8373 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8375 yes | yes | yes | yes
8376 Arguments : none
8377
8378 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8379 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8380 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8381 receive data or not.
8382
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008383 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008384 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8385 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8386 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8387 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8388 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8389 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8390 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8391 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8392 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8393 socket buffers.
8394
8395 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8396 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8397 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8398 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8399 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8400
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008401 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008402
8403
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008404option ldap-check
8405 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8407 yes | no | yes | yes
8408 Arguments : none
8409
8410 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8411 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8412 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8413 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8414
8415 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8416 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8417
8418 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8419 configure it.
8420
8421 Example :
8422 option ldap-check
8423
8424 See also : "option httpchk"
8425
8426
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008427option external-check
8428 Use external processes for server health checks
8429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8430 yes | no | yes | yes
8431
8432 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8433 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8434 command".
8435
8436 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8437
8438 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8439
8440
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008441option log-health-checks
8442no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008443 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8445 yes | no | yes | yes
8446 Arguments : none
8447
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008448 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8449 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8450 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008451
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008452 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8453 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8454 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8455 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8456 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8457
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008458 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008459 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008460
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008461 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8462 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8463 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008464
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008465
8466option log-separate-errors
8467no option log-separate-errors
8468 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8470 yes | yes | yes | no
8471 Arguments : none
8472
8473 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8474 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8475 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8476 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8477 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8478 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8479 provides very important information.
8480
8481 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8482 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8483 error logs.
8484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008485 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008486 logging.
8487
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008488
8489option logasap
8490no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008491 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8493 yes | yes | yes | no
8494 Arguments : none
8495
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008496 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8497 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8498 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8499 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8500
8501 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8502 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8503 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8504 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8505 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008506 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008507 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8508 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8509 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8510 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008511 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008512
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008513 Examples :
8514 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8515 mode http
8516 option httplog
8517 option logasap
8518 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8519
8520 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8521 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8522 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8523 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8524
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008525 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008526 logging.
8527
8528
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008529option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008530 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8532 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008533 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008534 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8535 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008536 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8537 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008538
8539 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8540 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008541 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008542 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8543 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8544 in the MySQL table, like this :
8545
8546 USE mysql;
8547 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8548 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8549
8550 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008551 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008552 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8553 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8554 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8555 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8556 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8557 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8558 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8559
8560 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8561 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008562
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008563 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008564
8565 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8566 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8567 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8568 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008569 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8570 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008571
8572 See also: "option httpchk"
8573
8574
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008575option nolinger
8576no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008577 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008578 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8579 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008580 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008581
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008582 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008583 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8584 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8585 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8586 connections.
8587
8588 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8589 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008590 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8591 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8592 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8593 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8594 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8595 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8596 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8597 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8598 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8599 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8600 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8601 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8602 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008603
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008604 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8605 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8606 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8607 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8608 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008609
8610 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8611 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008612 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
8613 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidently
8614 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008615
8616 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8617 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8618
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008619 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8620 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008621
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008622option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8623 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8625 yes | yes | yes | yes
8626 Arguments :
8627 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8628 matching <network>
8629 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8630 header name.
8631
8632 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8633 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8634 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8635 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8636 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8637 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8638 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8639 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8640 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8641 possible that the client has already brought one.
8642
8643 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8644 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8645 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8646 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8647 header and requires different one.
8648
8649 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8650 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8651 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8652 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8653 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8654 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8655 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8656
8657 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8658 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8659 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8660 both are defined.
8661
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008662 Examples :
8663 # Original Destination address
8664 frontend www
8665 mode http
8666 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8667
8668 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8669 backend www
8670 mode http
8671 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8672
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008673 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008674
8675
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008676option persist
8677no option persist
8678 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8679 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8680 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008681 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008682
8683 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8684 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8685 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8686 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8687 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8688 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8689 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8690 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8691 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8692 redirected to another valid server.
8693
8694 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8695 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8696
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008697 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008698
8699
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008700option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8701 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8703 yes | no | yes | yes
8704 Arguments :
8705 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8706 PostgreSQL server.
8707
8708 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8709 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8710 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8711 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8712
8713 See also: "option httpchk"
8714
8715
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008716option prefer-last-server
8717no option prefer-last-server
8718 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8719 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8720 yes | no | yes | yes
8721 Arguments : none
8722
8723 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8724 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8725 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8726 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8727 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8728 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8729 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8730 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8731 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008732 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8733 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008734 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8735 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8736 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008737 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8738 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8739 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008740
8741 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8742 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8743
8744 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8745
8746
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008747option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008748option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008749no option redispatch
8750 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8751 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8752 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008753 Arguments :
8754 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8755 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8756 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008757 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008758 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008759 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008760 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8761 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8762 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8763
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008764
8765 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8766 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8767 be able to access the service anymore.
8768
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008769 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8770 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008771
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008772 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8773 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8774 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8775 following order:
8776
8777 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8778
8779 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8780 list, or
8781
8782 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8783
8784 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8785 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8786
8787 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8788 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8789 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8790 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8791
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008792 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008793 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8794 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008795
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008796 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8797 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8798
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008799 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008800
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008801
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008802option redis-check
8803 Use redis health checks for server testing
8804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8805 yes | no | yes | yes
8806 Arguments : none
8807
8808 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8809 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8810 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8811 find the "+PONG" response message.
8812
8813 Example :
8814 option redis-check
8815
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008816 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008817
8818
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008819option smtpchk
8820option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8821 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8823 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008824 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008825 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008826 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008827 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8828
8829 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8830 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8831 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8832
8833 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8834 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8835 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8836 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8837 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8838 dead server.
8839
8840 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8841 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008842 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008843 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8844
8845 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8846 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8847 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8848 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008849 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008850
8851 Example :
8852 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8853
8854 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8855
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008856
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008857option socket-stats
8858no option socket-stats
8859
8860 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8862 yes | yes | yes | no
8863
8864 Arguments : none
8865
8866
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008867option splice-auto
8868no option splice-auto
8869 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8871 yes | yes | yes | yes
8872 Arguments : none
8873
8874 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8875 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008876 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008877 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008878 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008879 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8880 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8881 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8882 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8883
8884 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8885 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8886 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8887 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8888 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8889 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8890 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8891 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8892 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8893 keyword.
8894
8895 Example :
8896 option splice-auto
8897
8898 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8899 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8900
8901 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8902 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8903
8904
8905option splice-request
8906no option splice-request
8907 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8909 yes | yes | yes | yes
8910 Arguments : none
8911
8912 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008913 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008914 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8915 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8916 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8917 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8918
8919 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8920
8921 Example :
8922 option splice-request
8923
8924 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8925 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8926
8927 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8928 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8929
8930
8931option splice-response
8932no option splice-response
8933 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8935 yes | yes | yes | yes
8936 Arguments : none
8937
8938 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008939 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008940 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8941 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8942 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8943 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8944
8945 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8946
8947 Example :
8948 option splice-response
8949
8950 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8951 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8952
8953 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8954 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8955
8956
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008957option spop-check
8958 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8960 no | no | no | yes
8961 Arguments : none
8962
8963 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8964 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8965 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8966 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8967
8968 Example :
8969 option spop-check
8970
8971 See also : "option httpchk"
8972
8973
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008974option srvtcpka
8975no option srvtcpka
8976 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8978 yes | no | yes | yes
8979 Arguments : none
8980
8981 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8982 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008983 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008984 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8985
8986 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8987 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8988 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8989 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8990
8991 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8992 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8993 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8994 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8995 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8996
8997 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8998
8999 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9000 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9001 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9002
9003 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9004 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9005
9006 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9007
9008
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009009option ssl-hello-chk
9010 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9012 yes | no | yes | yes
9013 Arguments : none
9014
9015 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9016 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9017 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9018 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9019 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9020 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9021 hello message.
9022
9023 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9024 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9025 messages, which is appreciable.
9026
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009027 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9028 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9029 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009030
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009031 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9032
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009033
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009034option tcp-check
9035 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9036 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9037 yes | no | yes | yes
9038
9039 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9040 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9041
9042 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9043 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9044 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9045
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009046 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009047 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9048 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9049 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9050 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9051 only.
9052
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009053 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009054 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9055 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9056 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9057 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9058
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009059 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009060 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9061 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009062 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009063 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9064 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9065 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9066 the respective protocols.
9067 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009068 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009069
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009070 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009071
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009072 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9073 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9074 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9075 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009076
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009077 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9078 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9079 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009080
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009081
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009082 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009083 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009084 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009085 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009086
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009087 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009088 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009089 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009090
9091 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9092 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009093 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009094 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009095 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009096 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009097 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009098 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009099 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9100 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009101 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009102 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9103 tcp-check expect string +OK
9104
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009105 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009106 (send many headers before analyzing)
9107 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009108 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009109 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9110 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9111 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9112 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009113 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009114
9115
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009116 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009117
9118
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009119option tcp-smart-accept
9120no option tcp-smart-accept
9121 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9123 yes | yes | yes | no
9124 Arguments : none
9125
9126 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9127 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9128 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9129 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9130 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9131 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9132
9133 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9134 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9135 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9136 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9137
9138 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9139 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9140 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009141 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009142
9143 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9144 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9145 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9146
9147 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9148 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9149 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9150
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009151 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9152
9153
9154option tcp-smart-connect
9155no option tcp-smart-connect
9156 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9158 yes | no | yes | yes
9159 Arguments : none
9160
9161 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9162 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9163 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9164 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9165 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9166
9167 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9168 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9169 complex.
9170
9171 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9172 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9173 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9174
9175 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9176 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9177
9178 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9179
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009180
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009181option tcpka
9182 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9184 yes | yes | yes | yes
9185 Arguments : none
9186
9187 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9188 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009189 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009190 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9191
9192 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9193 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9194 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9195 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9196
9197 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9198 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9199 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9200 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9201 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9202
9203 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9204
9205 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9206 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9207 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9208 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9209 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9210 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9211 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9212 backends.
9213
9214 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9215
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009216
9217option tcplog
9218 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009220 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009221 Arguments : none
9222
9223 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9224 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9225 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9226 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9227 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9228 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9229 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9230 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9231
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009232 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009234 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009235
9236
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009237option transparent
9238no option transparent
9239 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009241 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009242 Arguments : none
9243
9244 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9245 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9246 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9247 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9248 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9249 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9250 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9251 appropriate server.
9252
9253 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9254 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9255
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009256 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009257 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009258
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009259
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009260external-check command <command>
9261 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9263 yes | no | yes | yes
9264
9265 Arguments :
9266 <command> is the external command to run
9267
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009268 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9269
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009270 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009271
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009272 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9273 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9274 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9275 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9276 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9277 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009278
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009279 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9280
9281 Environment variables :
9282 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9283 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9284
9285 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9286
9287 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9288
9289 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9290 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9291 for a UNIX socket).
9292
9293 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9294
9295 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9296
9297 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9298
9299 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9300
9301 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9302
9303 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9304 socket).
9305
9306 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9307 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9308
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009309 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9310
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009311 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9312 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9313 failed.
9314
9315 Example :
9316 external-check command /bin/true
9317
9318 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9319
9320
9321external-check path <path>
9322 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9324 yes | no | yes | yes
9325
9326 Arguments :
9327 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9328
9329 The default path is "".
9330
9331 Example :
9332 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9333
9334 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9335 "external-check command"
9336
9337
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009338persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009339persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009340 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9342 yes | no | yes | yes
9343 Arguments :
9344 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009345 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9346 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009347
9348 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9349 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009350 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009351 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9352 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9353 forwarded to this server.
9354
9355 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9356 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9357 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009358 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009359 a single "listen" section.
9360
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009361 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9362 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9363 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9364
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009365 Example :
9366 listen tse-farm
9367 bind :3389
9368 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9369 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9370 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9371 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9372 persist rdp-cookie
9373 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009374 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009375 balance rdp-cookie
9376 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9377 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9378
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009379 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9380 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009381
9382
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009383rate-limit sessions <rate>
9384 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9386 yes | yes | yes | no
9387 Arguments :
9388 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9389 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9390
9391 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9392 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9393 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9394 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9395 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9396 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9397
9398 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9399 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9400 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9401 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9402
9403 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9404 listen smtp
9405 mode tcp
9406 bind :25
9407 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009408 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009409
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009410 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9411 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9412 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009413
9414 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9415
9416
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009417redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9418redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9419redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009420 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9422 no | yes | yes | yes
9423
9424 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009425 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009426
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009427 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009428 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009429 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9430 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9431 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009432
9433 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9434 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9435 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9436 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9437 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009438 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9439 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9440 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9441 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009442
9443 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9444 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9445 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9446 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9447 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9448 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009449 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009450 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009451 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9452 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9453 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009454
9455 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009456 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9457 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9458 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009459 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009460 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9461 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9462 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9463 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009464
9465 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009466 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009467
9468 - "drop-query"
9469 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9470 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9471 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9472 with a location-type redirect.
9473
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009474 - "append-slash"
9475 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9476 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9477 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9478 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9479
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009480 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9481 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9482 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9483 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9484 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9485 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9486 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9487
9488 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9489 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9490 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9491 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9492 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9493 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9494 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009495
9496 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9497 acl clear dst_port 80
9498 acl secure dst_port 8080
9499 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009500 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009501 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009502 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9503
9504 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009505 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9506 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9507 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009508 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009509
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009510 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9511 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9512 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9513
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009514 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009515 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009516
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009517 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009518 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9519 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9520 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009522 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009523
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009524
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009525retries <value>
9526 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9527 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9528 yes | no | yes | yes
9529 Arguments :
9530 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9531 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9532 default value is 3.
9533
9534 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9535 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9536 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9537
9538 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009539 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9540 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009541
9542 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9543 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9544
9545 See also : "option redispatch"
9546
9547
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009548retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009549 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9550 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9551 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009552 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9553 yes | no | yes | yes
9554 Arguments :
9555 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9556 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9557 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9558 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9559
9560 none never retry
9561
9562 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9563 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9564
9565 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9566 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9567 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9568 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9569 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9570 processing the request.
9571
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009572 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9573 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9574 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9575 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9576 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9577 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9578 overflow attack for example).
9579
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009580 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9581 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9582 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9583 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9584 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9585 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9586 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9587 amplify denial of service attacks.
9588
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009589 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9590 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9591 considered to be safe to retry.
9592
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +01009593 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
9594 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
9595 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
9596 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
9597 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009598
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009599 all-retryable-errors
9600 retry request for any error that are considered
9601 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9602 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9603 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9604
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009605 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9606 not cumulative.
9607
9608 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9609 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9610 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9611 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9612
9613 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9614 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9615 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9616 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9617 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9618 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9619 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9620 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9621 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9622 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9623 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9624 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9625
9626 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9627 should not use this directive.
9628
9629 The default is "conn-failure".
9630
9631 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9632
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009633server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009634 Declare a server in a backend
9635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9636 no | no | yes | yes
9637 Arguments :
9638 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009639 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009640 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009641
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009642 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9643 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9644 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9645 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009646 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9647 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9648 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9649 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9650 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009651 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9652 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9653 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9654 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9655 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9656 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9657 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009658 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009659 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9660 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9661 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9662 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9663 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9664 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009665 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9666 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009667 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9668 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009669
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009670 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009671 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9672 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9673 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9674 adding this value to the client's port.
9675
9676 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9677 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009678 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009679
9680 Examples :
9681 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9682 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009683 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009684 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9685 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9686 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009687
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009688 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9689 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9690 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9691 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9692 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9693
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009694 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9695 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009696
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009697server-state-file-name [<file>]
9698 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9699 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9700 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9701 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9702 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9703 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9704
9705 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9706 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9707
9708 global
9709 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9710
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009711 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009712 load-server-state-from-file
9713
9714 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9715 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009716
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009717server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9718 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9719 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9721 no | no | yes | yes
9722
9723 Arguments:
9724 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9725
9726 <num | range>
9727 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9728 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9729 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9730 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9731
9732 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9733
9734 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9735
9736 <params*>
9737 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9738 keyword.
9739
9740 Examples:
9741 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9742 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9743 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9744
9745 # or
9746 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9747
9748 # would be equivalent to:
9749 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9750 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9751 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9752
9753
9754
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009755source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009756source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009757source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009758 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9760 yes | no | yes | yes
9761 Arguments :
9762 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9763 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009764
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009765 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009766 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9767 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9768 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9769 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9770 supported prefixes are :
9771 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9772 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9773 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009774 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009775 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9776 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009777
9778 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9779 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009780 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9781 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9782 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009783
9784 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9785 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9786 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9787 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9788 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9789 <addr>.
9790
9791 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9792 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9793 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9794 port.
9795
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009796 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9797 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9798 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9799 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009800 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009801 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9802 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9803 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9804 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9805 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9806 HTTP header.
9807
9808 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9809 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009810 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009811 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9812 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9813 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9814 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9815 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9816 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9817 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9818
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009819 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9820 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9821 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9822 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9823 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9824 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9825
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009826 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9827 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9828 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9829 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9830
9831 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9832 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9833 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9834 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9835 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9836 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9837
9838 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9839 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9840 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9841 there are two methods :
9842
9843 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9844 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9845 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9846 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9847 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9848 of the client ranges may be used.
9849
9850 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9851 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9852 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9853 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9854 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9855 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9856 same session.
9857
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009858 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9859 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9860 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009861 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009862
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009863 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9864
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009865 Examples :
9866 backend private
9867 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9868 source 192.168.1.200
9869
9870 backend transparent_ssl1
9871 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9872 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9873
9874 backend transparent_ssl2
9875 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9876 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9877 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9878
9879 backend transparent_ssl3
9880 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9881 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9882 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9883
9884 backend transparent_smtp
9885 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9886 # with Tproxy version 4.
9887 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9888
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009889 backend transparent_http
9890 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9891 # proxy.
9892 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9893
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009894 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009895 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9896
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009897
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009898srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9899 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9900 the connection on the server side.
9901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9902 yes | no | yes | yes
9903 Arguments :
9904 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9905
9906 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9907 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009908 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9909 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009910
9911 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9912
9913
9914srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9915 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9916 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9917 server side.
9918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9919 yes | no | yes | yes
9920 Arguments :
9921 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9922 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9923 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9924 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9925
9926 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9927 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009928 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9929 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009930
9931 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9932
9933
9934srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9935 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9937 yes | no | yes | yes
9938 Arguments :
9939 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9940 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9941 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9942 document.
9943
9944 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9945 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009946 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9947 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009948
9949 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9950
9951
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009952stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9953 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009955 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009956
9957 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9958 matched.
9959
9960 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9961 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9962
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009963 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9964 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009965 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009966
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009967 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9968 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9969 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9970 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009971
9972 Example :
9973 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9974 backend stats_localhost
9975 stats enable
9976 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9977
9978 Example :
9979 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9980 backend stats_auth
9981 stats enable
9982 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9983 stats admin if TRUE
9984
9985 Example :
9986 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9987 userlist stats-auth
9988 group admin users admin
9989 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9990 group readonly users haproxy
9991 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9992
9993 backend stats_auth
9994 stats enable
9995 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9996 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9997 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9998 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9999
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010000 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10001 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10002 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010003
10004
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010005stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10006 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010008 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010009 Arguments :
10010 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10011
10012 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10013
10014 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10015 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10016 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10017 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10018 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10019 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10020
10021 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10022 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10023 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010024 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010025
10026 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10027 report using "stats scope".
10028
10029 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10030 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10031 unobvious parameters.
10032
10033 Example :
10034 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10035 backend public_www
10036 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10037 stats enable
10038 stats hide-version
10039 stats scope .
10040 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010041 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010042 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10043 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10044
10045 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10046 backend private_monitoring
10047 stats enable
10048 stats uri /admin?stats
10049 stats refresh 5s
10050
10051 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10052
10053
10054stats enable
10055 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010057 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010058 Arguments : none
10059
10060 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10061 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10062 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10063 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10064 - stats auth : no authentication
10065 - stats scope : no restriction
10066
10067 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10068 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10069 unobvious parameters.
10070
10071 Example :
10072 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10073 backend public_www
10074 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10075 stats enable
10076 stats hide-version
10077 stats scope .
10078 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010079 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010080 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10081 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10082
10083 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10084 backend private_monitoring
10085 stats enable
10086 stats uri /admin?stats
10087 stats refresh 5s
10088
10089 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10090
10091
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010092stats hide-version
10093 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010095 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010096 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010097
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010098 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10099 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10100 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10101 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10102 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10103 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010104
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010105 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10106 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10107 unobvious parameters.
10108
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010109 Example :
10110 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10111 backend public_www
10112 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010113 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010114 stats hide-version
10115 stats scope .
10116 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010117 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010118 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10119 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010120
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010121 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10122 backend private_monitoring
10123 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010124 stats uri /admin?stats
10125 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010126
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010127 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010128
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010129
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010130stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10131 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10132 Access control for statistics
10133
10134 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10135 no | no | yes | yes
10136
10137 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10138 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10139 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10140 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10141 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10142 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10143
10144 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10145 instance.
10146
10147 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10148 about ACL usage.
10149
10150
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010151stats realm <realm>
10152 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010154 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010155 Arguments :
10156 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10157 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10158 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10159
10160 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10161 using a backslash ('\').
10162
10163 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10164 only related to authentication.
10165
10166 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10167 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10168 unobvious parameters.
10169
10170 Example :
10171 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10172 backend public_www
10173 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10174 stats enable
10175 stats hide-version
10176 stats scope .
10177 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010178 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010179 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10180 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10181
10182 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10183 backend private_monitoring
10184 stats enable
10185 stats uri /admin?stats
10186 stats refresh 5s
10187
10188 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10189
10190
10191stats refresh <delay>
10192 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010194 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010195 Arguments :
10196 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10197 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10198 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10199 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10200 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10201 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10202
10203 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10204 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10205 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010206 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010207
10208 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10209 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10210 unobvious parameters.
10211
10212 Example :
10213 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10214 backend public_www
10215 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10216 stats enable
10217 stats hide-version
10218 stats scope .
10219 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010220 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010221 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10222 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10223
10224 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10225 backend private_monitoring
10226 stats enable
10227 stats uri /admin?stats
10228 stats refresh 5s
10229
10230 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10231
10232
10233stats scope { <name> | "." }
10234 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010236 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010237 Arguments :
10238 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10239 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10240 section in which the statement appears.
10241
10242 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10243 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10244 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10245 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10246 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10247 exists.
10248
10249 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10250 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10251 unobvious parameters.
10252
10253 Example :
10254 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10255 backend public_www
10256 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10257 stats enable
10258 stats hide-version
10259 stats scope .
10260 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010261 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010262 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10263 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10264
10265 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10266 backend private_monitoring
10267 stats enable
10268 stats uri /admin?stats
10269 stats refresh 5s
10270
10271 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10272
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010273
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010274stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010275 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010277 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010278
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010279 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010280 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10281
10282 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10283 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10284
10285 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10286 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010287 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010288
10289 Example :
10290 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10291 backend private_monitoring
10292 stats enable
10293 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10294 stats uri /admin?stats
10295 stats refresh 5s
10296
10297 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10298 global section.
10299
10300
10301stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010302 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10304 yes | yes | yes | yes
10305 Arguments : none
10306
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010307 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010308 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10309 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10310 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10311 - IP (socket, server)
10312 - cookie (backend, server)
10313
10314 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10315 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010316 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010317
10318 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10319
10320
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010321stats show-modules
10322 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10324 yes | yes | yes | yes
10325 Arguments : none
10326
10327 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10328 values as a tooltip.
10329
10330 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10331 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10332 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10333
10334 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10335
10336
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010337stats show-node [ <name> ]
10338 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010340 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010341 Arguments:
10342 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10343 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10344
10345 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10346 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010347 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010348
10349 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10350 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10351 unobvious parameters.
10352
10353 Example:
10354 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10355 backend private_monitoring
10356 stats enable
10357 stats show-node Europe-1
10358 stats uri /admin?stats
10359 stats refresh 5s
10360
10361 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10362 section.
10363
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010364
10365stats uri <prefix>
10366 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010368 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010369 Arguments :
10370 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10371 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10372 query string.
10373
10374 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10375 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10376 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10377 possible to reach it in the application.
10378
10379 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010380 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010381 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10382 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10383 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10384 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10385
10386 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10387 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10388 an address or a port to statistics only.
10389
10390 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10391 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10392 unobvious parameters.
10393
10394 Example :
10395 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10396 backend public_www
10397 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10398 stats enable
10399 stats hide-version
10400 stats scope .
10401 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010402 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010403 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10404 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10405
10406 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10407 backend private_monitoring
10408 stats enable
10409 stats uri /admin?stats
10410 stats refresh 5s
10411
10412 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10413
10414
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010415stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10416 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010418 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010419
10420 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010421 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010422 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010423 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010424 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10425
10426 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10427 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10428 the "stick-table" statement.
10429
10430 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10431 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10432 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10433 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10434 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10435
10436 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10437 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10438 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10439 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10440 transformation rules.
10441
10442 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10443 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10444 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10445 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10446 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10447 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10448 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10449
10450 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10451 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10452 ACL based conditions.
10453
10454 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10455 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10456 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10457 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10458
10459 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10460 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10461 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10462 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10463
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010464 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10465 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010466 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010467
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010468 Example :
10469 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10470 # last 30 minutes
10471 backend pop
10472 mode tcp
10473 balance roundrobin
10474 stick store-request src
10475 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10476 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10477 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10478
10479 backend smtp
10480 mode tcp
10481 balance roundrobin
10482 stick match src table pop
10483 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10484 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10485
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010486 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010487 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010488
10489
10490stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10491 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10493 no | no | yes | yes
10494
10495 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10496 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10497 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10498 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10499
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010500 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10501 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010502 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010503
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010504 Examples :
10505 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010506 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010507
10508 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10509 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10510 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10511
10512
10513 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10514 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10515 backend http
10516 mode http
10517 balance roundrobin
10518 stick on src table https
10519 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10520 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10521 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10522
10523 backend https
10524 mode tcp
10525 balance roundrobin
10526 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10527 stick on src
10528 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10529 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10530
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010531 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010532
10533
10534stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10535 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10537 no | no | yes | yes
10538
10539 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010540 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010541 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010542 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010543 server is selected.
10544
10545 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10546 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10547 the "stick-table" statement.
10548
10549 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10550 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10551 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10552 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10553 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10554 address.
10555
10556 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10557 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10558 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10559 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10560 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10561 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10562 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10563 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10564 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10565 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10566
10567 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10568 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10569 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10570 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10571 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10572 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10573 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10574
10575 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10576 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10577 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10578 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10579
10580 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10581 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10582 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10583 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10584 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10585 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010586 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10587 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10588 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10589 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10590 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10591 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010592
10593 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10594 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10595 the request.
10596
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010597 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10598 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010599 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010600
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010601 Example :
10602 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10603 # last 30 minutes
10604 backend pop
10605 mode tcp
10606 balance roundrobin
10607 stick store-request src
10608 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10609 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10610 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10611
10612 backend smtp
10613 mode tcp
10614 balance roundrobin
10615 stick match src table pop
10616 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10617 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10618
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010619 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010620 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010621
10622
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010623stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010624 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10625 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010626 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010628 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010629
10630 Arguments :
10631 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10632 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10633 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10634 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10635
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010636 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10637 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10638 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10639 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10640
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010641 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10642 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10643 instance.
10644
10645 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10646 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10647 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10648 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10649 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10650 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010651 to 32 characters.
10652
10653 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10654 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10655 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010656 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010657 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10658 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010659
10660 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010661 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10662 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010663 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10664 increase.
10665
10666 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010667 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10668 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10669 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010670
10671 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10672 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10673 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10674 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010675 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010676 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10677 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10678 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10679 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10680 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10681 parameter (see below).
10682
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010683 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10684 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10685 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10686 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10687 soft restart.
10688
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010689 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10690 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010691
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010692 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10693 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10694 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10695 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010696 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010697 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010698 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10699 if not expiration delay is specified.
10700
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010701 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10702 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10703 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10704 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010705 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10706 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10707 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10708 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10709 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10710 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10711 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10712 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10713 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10714 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10715 types and their arguments.
10716
10717 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10718 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10719 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10720 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10721
10722 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10723 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10724 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010725 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010726
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010727 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10728 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10729 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010730 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010731 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010732 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010733
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010734 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10735 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10736 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10737 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10738
10739 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10740 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10741 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10742 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10743 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10744 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10745
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010746 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10747 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10748 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10749 they were received.
10750
10751 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10752 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10753 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10754 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10755 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10756
10757 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10758 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10759 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10760 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10761 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10762
10763 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10764 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10765 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10766
10767 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10768 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10769 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10770 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10771 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10772
10773 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10774 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10775 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10776 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10777 the client side.
10778
10779 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10780 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10781 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10782 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10783 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10784 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10785 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10786
10787 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10788 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10789 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10790 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10791 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10792 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010793 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010794
10795 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10796 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10797 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10798 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10799 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10800 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10801
10802 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010803 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010804 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10805 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10806
10807 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10808 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10809 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10810 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10811 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10812 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10813 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10814 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10815 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10816 recommended for better fairness.
10817
10818 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010819 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010820 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10821 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10822
10823 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10824 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10825 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10826 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10827 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10828 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10829 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10830 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10831 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10832 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010833
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010834 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10835 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010836 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10837 reference it.
10838
10839 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10840 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010841 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10842 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10843 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010844
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010845 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10846 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10847 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10848 something that can be ignored.
10849
10850 Example:
10851 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10852 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10853 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10854 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10855
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010856 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010857 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010858
10859
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010860stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010861 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10863 no | no | yes | yes
10864
10865 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010866 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010867 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010868 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010869 server is selected.
10870
10871 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10872 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10873 the "stick-table" statement.
10874
10875 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10876 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10877 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10878 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10879
10880 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10881 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10882 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10883 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10884 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10885 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010886 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010887 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10888 rules.
10889
10890 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10891 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10892 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10893 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10894 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10895 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10896 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10897
10898 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10899 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10900 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10901 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10902
10903 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10904 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10905 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10906 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10907 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10908 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010909 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10910 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10911 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10912 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10913 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10914 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10915 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10916 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10917 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010918
10919 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10920
10921 Example :
10922 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10923 backend https
10924 mode tcp
10925 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010926 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010927 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010928
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010929 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10930 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10931
10932 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10933 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10934 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10935
10936 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10937 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010938
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010939 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10940 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10941 # at offset 44.
10942
10943 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10944 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10945
10946 # Learn on response if server hello.
10947 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010948
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010949 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10950 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10951
10952 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10953 extraction.
10954
10955
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010956tcp-check comment <string>
10957 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10958 it fails.
10959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10960 yes | no | yes | yes
10961
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010962 Arguments :
10963 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10964 rule fails.
10965
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010966 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10967 user-friendly error reporting.
10968
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010969 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10970 "tcp-check expect".
10971
10972
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010973tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10974 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010975 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010976 Opens a new connection
10977 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010978 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010979
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010980 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010981 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10982
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010983 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010984 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010985
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010986 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010987 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10988 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010989 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010990
10991 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010992
10993 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10994
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010995 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10996
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010997 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10998
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010999 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11000
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011001 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11002 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11003 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11004 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11005
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011006 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11007 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11008 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11009 haproxy -vv.
11010
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011011 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011012
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011013 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11014 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11015 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11016
11017 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11018 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11019 of the sequence.
11020
11021 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11022 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11023 do.
11024
11025 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11026 unset-var or comment rules.
11027
11028 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011029 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11030 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11031 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11032 option tcp-check
11033 tcp-check connect
11034 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11035 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11036 tcp-check send \r\n
11037 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11038 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11039 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11040 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11041 tcp-check send \r\n
11042 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11043 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11044
11045 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11046 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011047 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011048 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11049 tcp-check connect port 143
11050 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11051 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11052
11053 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11054
11055
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011056tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011057 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011058 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011059 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011060 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011061 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011062 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011063
11064 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011065 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11066
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011067 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11068 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11069 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11070 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11071 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11072 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11073 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11074 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11075 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11076 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11077
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011078 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011079 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11080 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011081 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11082 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11083 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11084
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011085 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11086 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11087 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011088 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11089 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011090 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11091 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011092 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11093 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011094 By default "L7OK" is used.
11095
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011096 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11097 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011098 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11099 supported :
11100 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11101 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011102 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11103 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11104 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11105 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11106 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011107
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011108 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011109 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011110 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11111 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11112 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11113 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011114 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11115
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011116 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11117 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11118 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11119 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11120
11121 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11122 informational message reported in logs if an error
11123 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11124 log-format string.
11125
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011126 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11127 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11128 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11129 followed by some converters.
11130
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011131 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11132 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11133 with the usual backslash ('\').
11134 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011135 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011136 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11137 used upper or lower case.
11138
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011139 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11140
11141 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11142 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11143 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11144 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11145 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11146 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11147 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11148 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11149
11150 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11151 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11152 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11153 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11154 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11155 expression.
11156
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011157 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11158 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11159 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11160 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11161 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11162 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11163
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011164 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11165 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11166 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11167 this exact hexadecimal string.
11168 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11169
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011170 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11171 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11172 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11173 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11174 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11175 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11176 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11177 size.
11178
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011179 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11180 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11181 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11182 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11183 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11184 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11185 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11186 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11187 in a binary string before matching the response's
11188 buffer.
11189
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011190 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011191 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011192 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11193 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11194 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11195 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11196 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11197 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11198 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11199 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11200 the null character.
11201
11202 Examples :
11203 # perform a POP check
11204 option tcp-check
11205 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11206
11207 # perform an IMAP check
11208 option tcp-check
11209 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11210
11211 # look for the redis master server
11212 option tcp-check
11213 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011214 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011215 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11216 tcp-check expect string role:master
11217 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11218 tcp-check expect string +OK
11219
11220
11221 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011222 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011223
11224
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011225tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11226tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11227 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11228 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011229 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011230 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011231
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011232 Arguments :
11233 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11234
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011235 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11236 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011237
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011238 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11239 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011240
11241 Examples :
11242 # look for the redis master server
11243 option tcp-check
11244 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11245 tcp-check expect string role:master
11246
11247 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011248 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011249
11250
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011251tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11252tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11253 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11254 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011255 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011256 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011257
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011258 Arguments :
11259 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011260
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011261 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11262 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011263
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011264 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11265 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11266 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011267
11268 Examples :
11269 # redis check in binary
11270 option tcp-check
11271 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11272 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11273
11274
11275 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011276 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011277
11278
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011279tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011280 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011281 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011282 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011283
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011284 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011285 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11286 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11287 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11288 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11289 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11290 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11291 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11292 and '-'.
11293
11294 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11295
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011296 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011297 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11298
11299
11300tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011301 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011302 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011303 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011304
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011305 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011306 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11307 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11308 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11309 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11310 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11311 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11312 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11313 and '-'.
11314
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011315 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011316 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11317
11318
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011319tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11320 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11322 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011323 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011324 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11325 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011326
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011327 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011328
11329 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11330 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011331 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11332 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11333 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11334 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11335 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11336 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011337
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011338 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11339 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11340 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11341 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011342
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011343 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011344 - accept :
11345 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11346 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11347 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011348
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011349 - reject :
11350 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11351 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11352 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11353 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11354 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11355 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11356 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11357 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11358 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11359 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11360 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011361 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011362
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011363 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11364 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11365 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11366 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11367 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11368 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11369 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11370 hosts.
11371
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011372 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11373 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11374 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11375 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11376 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11377 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11378 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11379 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11380
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011381 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11382 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11383 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11384 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11385 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11386 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11387 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11388 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11389 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011390 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11391 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011392
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011393 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011394 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011395 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11396 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11397 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011398 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011399 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011400 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11401 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11402 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11403 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11404 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11405 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11406 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011407
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011408 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011409 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011410 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011411 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011412 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11413 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11414 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011415
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011416 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11417 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11418 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11419 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011420
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011421 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11422 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11423 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11424 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11425 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011426 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11427 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11428 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11429 layer7 information is extracted.
11430
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011431 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11432 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11433 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11434 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11435 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011436
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011437 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11438 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11439 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11440 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11441
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011442 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11443 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11444 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11445 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11446
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011447 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11448 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11449 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11450 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11451 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011452
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011453 - set-src <expr> :
11454 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11455 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11456 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011457 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011458
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011459 Arguments:
11460 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11461 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011462
11463 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011464 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11465
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011466 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11467 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011468
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011469 - set-src-port <expr> :
11470 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11471 expression.
11472
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011473 Arguments:
11474 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11475 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011476
11477 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011478 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11479
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011480 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11481 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11482 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011483
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011484 - set-dst <expr> :
11485 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11486 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11487 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11488 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11489 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11490
11491 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11492 followed by some converters.
11493
11494 Example:
11495
11496 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11497 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11498
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011499 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11500 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11501
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011502 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11503 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11504 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11505 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11506
11507
11508 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11509 followed by some converters.
11510
11511 Example:
11512
11513 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11514
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011515 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11516 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11517 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11518
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011519 - "silent-drop" :
11520 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011521 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011522 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11523 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11524 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11525 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11526 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011527 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11528 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011529 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11530 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011531 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011532 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11533 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11534 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11535 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11536
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011537 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11538 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11539 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011540
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011541 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11542 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11543 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011544
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011545 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011546 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011547 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011548
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011549 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11550 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11551 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011552
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011553 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011554 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11555 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011556
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011557 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11558
11559 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11560
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011561 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11562
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011563 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011564
11565
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011566tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11567 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011569 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011570 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011571 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11572 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011573
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011574 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011575
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011576 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011577 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11578 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11579 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11580 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011581
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011582 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11583 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11584 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11585 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011586 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11587 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11588 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11589 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11590 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11591 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011592 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011593 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011594
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011595 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11596 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11597 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11598 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011599
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011600 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011601 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011602 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011603 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11604 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011605 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011606 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011607 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011608 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011609 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011610 - set-dst <expr>
11611 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011612 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011613 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011614 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011615 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011616 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011617
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011618 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11619 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011620 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11621 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011622
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011623 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11624 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11625 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11626 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11627 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11628 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011630 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011631 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11632 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011633
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011634 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11635 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11636 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11637 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11638 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11639 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11640
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011641 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011642 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11643 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11644 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11645 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11646 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11647 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11648 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11649 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11650 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11651 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011652
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011653 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011654 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11655 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11656 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011657
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011658 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11659 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11660
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011661 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011662 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11663 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011664
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011665 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11666 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011667 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011668 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11669 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011670 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011671 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011672 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011673 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11674 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011675 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011676 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11677 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011678
11679 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11680 followed by some converters.
11681
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011682 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11683 <var-name>.
11684
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011685 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11686 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11687 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11688 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11689 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11690
11691 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11692 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11693 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11694 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11695 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11696 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11697 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11698 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11699 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11700 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11701 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11702
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011703 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11704 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11705 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11706 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11707 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11708
11709 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11710
11711 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11712
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011713 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11714 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11715 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11716 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11717 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11718 evaluated.
11719
11720 Example:
11721 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11722
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011723 Example:
11724
11725 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011726 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011727
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011728 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011729 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11730 # and reject everything else.
11731 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11732 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011733 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011734 tcp-request content reject
11735
11736 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011737 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11738 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11739 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011740 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011741
11742 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11743 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11744 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011745 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011746 tcp-request content reject
11747
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011748 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011749 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011750 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011751 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011752 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11753 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011754
11755 Example:
11756 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11757 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011758 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011759
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011760 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011761 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011762
11763 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011764 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011765 # protecting all our sites
11766 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011767 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11768 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011769 ...
11770 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11771
11772 backend http_dynamic
11773 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011774 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011775 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011776 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011777 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011778 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011779 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011780
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011781 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011782
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011783 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11784 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011785
11786
11787tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11788 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011790 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011791 Arguments :
11792 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11793 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11794 as explained at the top of this document.
11795
11796 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11797 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11798 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11799 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11800 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11801
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011802 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11803 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11804 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11805 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11806
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011807 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11808 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011809 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011810 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011811 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11812 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11813 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11814 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011815
11816 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11817 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11818 it pass through unaffected.
11819
11820 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11821 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11822 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011823 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011824 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11825 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011826 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11827 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11828 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011829
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011830 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011831 "timeout client".
11832
11833
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011834tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11835 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11837 no | no | yes | yes
11838 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011839 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11840 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011841
11842 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11843
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011844 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011845 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11846 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011847 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11848 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011849
11850 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11851
11852 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11853 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11854 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11855 inserted.
11856
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011857 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011858 - accept :
11859 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11860 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11861 the rules evaluation.
11862
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011863 - close :
11864 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11865 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11866 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11867 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11868 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11869 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011870 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011871 protocols.
11872
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011873 - reject :
11874 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11875 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011876 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011877
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011878 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11879 Sets a variable.
11880
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011881 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11882 Unsets a variable.
11883
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011884 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11885 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11886 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11887 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11888
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011889 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11890 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11891 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11892 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11893
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011894 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11895 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11896 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11897 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11898 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011899
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011900 - "silent-drop" :
11901 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011902 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011903 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11904 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11905 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11906 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11907 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011908 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11909 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011910 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11911 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011912 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011913 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11914 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11915 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11916 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11917
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011918 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11919 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11920
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011921 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11922 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11923 for changing the default action to a reject.
11924
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011925 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11926 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11927 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11928 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011929 period.
11930
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011931 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11932 declared inline.
11933
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011934 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11935 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011936 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011937 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11938 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011939 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011940 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011941 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011942 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11943 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011944 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011945 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11946 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011947
11948 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11949 followed by some converters.
11950
11951 Example:
11952
11953 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11954
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011955 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11956 <var-name>.
11957
11958 Example:
11959
11960 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11961
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011962 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11963 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11964 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11965 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11966 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11967
11968 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11969
11970 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11971
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011972 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11973
11974 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11975
11976
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011977tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11978 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11980 no | yes | yes | no
11981 Arguments :
11982 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11983 below.
11984
11985 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11986
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011987 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011988 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11989 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11990 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11991 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11992 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11993 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11994 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011995 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011996 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11997 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11998 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11999 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12000 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12001 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12002 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12003 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12004 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12005 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12006 instead.
12007
12008 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12009 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12010 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12011 rules which may be inserted.
12012
12013 Several types of actions are supported :
12014 - accept : the request is accepted
12015 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12016 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12017 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012018 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012019 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012020 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012021 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012022 - silent-drop
12023
12024 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12025 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12026 sections for a complete description.
12027
12028 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12029 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12030 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12031
12032 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12033 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12034 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12035 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12036 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12037
12038 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12039 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12040
12041 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12042 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12043 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12044
12045 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12046 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12047 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12048
12049 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12050 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12051 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12052
12053 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12054 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12055 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12056
12057 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12058
12059 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12060
12061
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012062tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12063 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12065 no | no | yes | yes
12066 Arguments :
12067 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12068 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12069 as explained at the top of this document.
12070
12071 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12072
12073
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012074timeout check <timeout>
12075 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12076 established.
12077
12078 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12079 yes | no | yes | yes
12080 Arguments:
12081 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12082 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12083 as explained at the top of this document.
12084
12085 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12086 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012087 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012088 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012089 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12090 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12091 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012092
12093 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12094 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12095
12096 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12097 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012098 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012099
12100 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12101 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12102 forget about it.
12103
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012104 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12105 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012106
12107
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012108timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012109 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12111 yes | yes | yes | no
12112 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012113 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012114 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12115 as explained at the top of this document.
12116
12117 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12118 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12119 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012120 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12121 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12122 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12123 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012124 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12125 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12126 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012127 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012128 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012129 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12130 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012131 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12132 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012133
12134 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12135 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12136 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12137 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012138 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012139 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12140
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012141 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012142
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012143 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012144
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012145
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012146timeout client-fin <timeout>
12147 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12149 yes | yes | yes | no
12150 Arguments :
12151 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12152 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12153 as explained at the top of this document.
12154
12155 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12156 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12157 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12158 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12159 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12160 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12161 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012162 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12163 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12164 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012165
12166 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12167 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12168 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12169
12170 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12171
12172
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012173timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012174 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12176 yes | no | yes | yes
12177 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012178 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012179 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12180 as explained at the top of this document.
12181
12182 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012183 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012184 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012185 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012186 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12187 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012188
12189 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12190 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12191 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12192 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012193 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012194 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12195
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012196 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012197
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012198
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012199timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12200 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12202 yes | yes | yes | yes
12203 Arguments :
12204 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12205 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12206 as explained at the top of this document.
12207
12208 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12209 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12210 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12211 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12212 once the request has started to present itself.
12213
12214 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12215 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12216 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12217 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12218 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12219
12220 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12221 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12222 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12223 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12224
12225 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12226 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012227 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012228 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12229 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012230 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012231
12232 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12233 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12234 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12235 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12236
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012237 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12238 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012239 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12240
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012241 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12242
12243
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012244timeout http-request <timeout>
12245 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012247 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012248 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012249 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012250 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12251 as explained at the top of this document.
12252
12253 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12254 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12255 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12256 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12257 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12258 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12259 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012260 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12261 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12262 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12263 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012264 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012265 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12266 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012267
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012268 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12269 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12270 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12271 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12272 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012273 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012274
12275 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12276 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012277 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012278 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12279 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12280
12281 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012282 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12283 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12284 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012285
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012286 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012287 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012288
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012289
12290timeout queue <timeout>
12291 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12293 yes | no | yes | yes
12294 Arguments :
12295 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12296 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12297 as explained at the top of this document.
12298
12299 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12300 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12301 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12302 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12303 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12304
12305 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12306 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12307 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12308 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12309
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012310 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012311
12312
12313timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012314 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12316 yes | no | yes | yes
12317 Arguments :
12318 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12319 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12320 as explained at the top of this document.
12321
12322 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12323 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12324 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12325 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12326 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12327 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12328 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12329
12330 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12331 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12332 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12333 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12334 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012335 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012336 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012337 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12338 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012339 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12340 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012341
12342 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12343 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12344 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12345 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012346 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012347 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12348
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012349 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012350
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012351
12352timeout server-fin <timeout>
12353 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12355 yes | no | yes | yes
12356 Arguments :
12357 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12358 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12359 as explained at the top of this document.
12360
12361 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12362 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12363 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12364 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12365 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12366 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12367 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12368 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12369 situations, it should not be needed.
12370
12371 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12372 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12373 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12374
12375 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12376
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012377
12378timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012379 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12381 yes | yes | yes | yes
12382 Arguments :
12383 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12384 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12385 as explained at the top of this document.
12386
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012387 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12388 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12389 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012390
12391 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12392 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12393 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12394 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012395 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012396
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012397 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012398
12399
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012400timeout tunnel <timeout>
12401 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12403 yes | no | yes | yes
12404 Arguments :
12405 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12406 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12407 as explained at the top of this document.
12408
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012409 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012410 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12411 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12412 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012413 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12414 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012415 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12416 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12417 specified.
12418
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012419 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12420 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12421 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12422 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12423 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12424 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12425 state.
12426
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012427 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12428 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12429 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12430 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012431 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012432
12433 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12434 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12435 forget about it.
12436
12437 Example :
12438 defaults http
12439 option http-server-close
12440 timeout connect 5s
12441 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012442 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012443 timeout server 30s
12444 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12445
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012446 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012447
12448
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012449transparent (deprecated)
12450 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012452 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012453 Arguments : none
12454
12455 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12456 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12457 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12458 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12459 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12460 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12461 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12462 appropriate server.
12463
12464 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12465
12466 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12467 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12468
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012469 See also: "option transparent"
12470
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012471unique-id-format <string>
12472 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12474 yes | yes | yes | no
12475 Arguments :
12476 <string> is a log-format string.
12477
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012478 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12479 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12480 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12481 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012482
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012483 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12484 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12485 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12486 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12487 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12488 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12489 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12490 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012491
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012492 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12493 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012494
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012495 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012496
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012497 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012498
12499 will generate:
12500
12501 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12502
12503 See also: "unique-id-header"
12504
12505unique-id-header <name>
12506 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12508 yes | yes | yes | no
12509 Arguments :
12510 <name> is the name of the header.
12511
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012512 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12513 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012514
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012515 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012516
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012517 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012518 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12519
12520 will generate:
12521
12522 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12523
12524 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012525
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012526use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012527 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12529 no | yes | yes | no
12530 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012531 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12532 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012533
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012534 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12535 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012536
12537 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12538 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12539 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012540 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012541 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012542 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12543 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012544
12545 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12546 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12547 assign the backend.
12548
12549 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12550 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12551 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12552 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12553 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12554 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12555
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012556 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012557 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012558 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12559 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12560 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12561
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012562 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12563 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12564 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12565 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12566 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12567 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12568 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12569 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12570 cannot be forced from the request.
12571
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012572 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012573 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12574 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12575
12576 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12577 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012578
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012579use-fcgi-app <name>
12580 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12582 no | no | yes | yes
12583 Arguments :
12584 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12585
12586 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012587
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012588use-server <server> if <condition>
12589use-server <server> unless <condition>
12590 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12592 no | no | yes | yes
12593 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012594 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12595 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012596
12597 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12598
12599 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12600 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12601 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12602
12603 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12604 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12605 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12606 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12607 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12608 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12609 matches will assign the server.
12610
12611 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12612 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12613 with the next rules until one matches.
12614
12615 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12616 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12617 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12618 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12619
12620 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12621 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12622 stripped.
12623
12624 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12625 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012626 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12627 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12628 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012629
12630 Example :
12631 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12632 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12633 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12634 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012635 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012636 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012637 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012638 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12639 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12640
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012641 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12642 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12643 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12644 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012645 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012646 and we fall back to load balancing.
12647
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012648 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012649
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012650
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100126515. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012652--------------------------
12653
12654The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12655depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12656settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12657written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12658described in this section.
12659
12660
126615.1. Bind options
12662-----------------
12663
12664The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12665as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12666no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12667parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12668while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12669provided immediately after the setting name.
12670
12671The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12672
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012673accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12674 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12675 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12676 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12677 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12678 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12679 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12680 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12681 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12682 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012683 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12684 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12685 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012686
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012687accept-proxy
12688 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012689 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12690 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012691 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12692 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12693 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12694 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012695 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012696 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12697 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012698 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12699 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012700
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012701allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012702 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012703 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012704 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012705 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12706 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012707
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012708alpn <protocols>
12709 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12710 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12711 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012712 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012713 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012714 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12715 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12716 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12717 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12718 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12719 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12720 preference, like below :
12721
12722 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012723
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012724backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012725 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012726 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12727
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012728curves <curves>
12729 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12730 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12731 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12732 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12733 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12734 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12735
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012736ecdhe <named curve>
12737 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012738 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12739 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012740
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012741ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012742 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12743 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12744 client's certificate.
12745
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012746ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12747 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12748 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12749 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12750 error is ignored.
12751
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012752ca-sign-file <cafile>
12753 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12754 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12755 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12756 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12757 'generate-certificates' for details.
12758
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012759ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012760 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12761 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12762 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12763 'generate-certificates' for details.
12764
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012765ca-verify-file <cafile>
12766 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12767 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12768 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12769 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12770 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12771
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012772ciphers <ciphers>
12773 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12774 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012775 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012776 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012777 information and recommendations see e.g.
12778 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12779 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12780 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12781
12782ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12783 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12784 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12785 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12786 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012787 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12788 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012789
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012790crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012791 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12792 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12793 to verify client's certificate.
12794
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012795crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012796 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12797 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12798 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12799 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12800 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012801 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12802 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012803
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012804 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12805 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12806
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012807 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12808 are loaded.
12809
12810 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012811 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12812 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12813 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12814 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12815 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12816 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12817 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012818 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012819
12820 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12821 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12822 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12823 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012824 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12825 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012826
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012827 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012828
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012829 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012830 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012831 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12832 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012833 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12834 clients).
12835
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012836 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12837 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12838 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12839 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12840 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12841 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12842 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12843 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12844 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12845 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12846 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12847 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12848 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12849
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012850 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12851 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12852 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12853 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12854 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12855
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012856 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12857 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12858 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12859 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012860
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012861 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12862 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12863 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012864
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012865crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012866 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012867 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012868 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012869 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012870
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012871crt-list <file>
12872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012873 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12874 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012875
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012876 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12877
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012878 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12879 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12880 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12881 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12882 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012883
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012884 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012885 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
12886 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
12887 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
12888 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
12889 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012890 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12891 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12892 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012893
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012894 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12895 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12896 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012897
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012898 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12899
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030012900 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
12901 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
12902 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
12903 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
12904 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
12905 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
12906 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
12907 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012908
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012909 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012910 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012911 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012912 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012913 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012914 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012915
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012916defer-accept
12917 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12918 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12919 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012920 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012921 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12922 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12923 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12924 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12925 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12926 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12927 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12928
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012929expose-fd listeners
12930 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12931 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012932 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12933 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012934 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012935
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012936force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012937 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012938 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012939 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012940 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012941
12942force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012943 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012944 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012945 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012946
12947force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012948 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012949 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012950 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012951
12952force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012953 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012954 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012955 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012956
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012957force-tlsv13
12958 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12959 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012960 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012961
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012962generate-certificates
12963 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12964 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12965 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12966 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12967 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12968 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12969 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12970 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12971 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12972 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12973 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12974
12975 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12976 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012977 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012978 certificate is used many times.
12979
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012980gid <gid>
12981 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12982 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12983 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12984 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12985 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12986
12987group <group>
12988 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12989 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12990 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12991 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12992 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12993
12994id <id>
12995 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12996 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12997 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12998 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12999
13000interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013001 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13002 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13003 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13004 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13005 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13006 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013007 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13008 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13009 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13010 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13011 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13012 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013013
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013014level <level>
13015 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13016 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13017 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013018 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013019 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13020 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13021 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013022 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013023 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013024 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013025 all counters).
13026
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013027severity-output <format>
13028 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13029 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13030 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13031 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13032 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13033 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13034 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13035 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13036 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13037 rfc5424 convention.
13038
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013039maxconn <maxconn>
13040 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13041 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13042 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13043 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13044 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13045 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13046 eat all memory.
13047
13048mode <mode>
13049 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13050 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13051 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13052 UNIX sockets.
13053
13054mss <maxseg>
13055 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13056 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13057 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13058 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13059 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13060 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13061 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13062 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13063 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13064 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13065 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13066
13067name <name>
13068 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13069 page.
13070
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013071namespace <name>
13072 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13073 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13074 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13075 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13076
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013077nice <nice>
13078 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13079 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13080 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13081 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13082 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13083 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13084 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13085 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13086 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13087 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13088 one for an RDP socket.
13089
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013090no-ca-names
13091 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13092 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013093 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013094
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013095no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013096 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013097 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013098 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013099 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013100 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13101 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013102
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013103no-tls-tickets
13104 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13105 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13106 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013107 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13108 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013109 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13110 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13111 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013112
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013113no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013114 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013115 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013116 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013117 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013118 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13119 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013120
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013121no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013122 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013123 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013124 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013125 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013126 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13127 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013128
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013129no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013130 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013131 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013132 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013133 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013134 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13135 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013136
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013137no-tlsv13
13138 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13139 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13140 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13141 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013142 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13143 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013144
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013145npn <protocols>
13146 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13147 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13148 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013149 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013150 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013151 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13152 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13153 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13154 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13155 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013156
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013157prefer-client-ciphers
13158 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13159 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13160 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013161 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13162 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13163 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013164
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013165process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013166 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013167 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013168 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013169 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13170 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13171 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13172 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013173 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013174 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13175 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13176 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13177 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13178 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013179
13180 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13181
13182 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13183 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13184 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13185 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13186 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13187 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13188 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13189 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013190
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013191proto <name>
13192 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13193 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13194 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
13195 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013196 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013197 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013198 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013199 h2" on the bind line.
13200
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013201ssl
13202 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013203 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013204 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13205 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013206 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13207 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013208
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013209ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13210 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013211 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13212 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13213 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013214 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13215
13216ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013217 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13218 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13219 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13220 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013221
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013222strict-sni
13223 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13224 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13225 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13226 See the "crt" option for more information.
13227
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013228tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013229 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013230 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13231 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013232 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013233 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13234 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13235 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13236 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13237 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13238 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13239 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13240
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013241tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013242 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013243 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13244 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13245 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13246 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13247 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13248 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13249 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013250 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13251 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13252 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013253
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013254tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13255 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013256 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13257 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13258 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13259 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13260 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13261 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13262 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13263 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13264 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13265 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013266 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13267 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13268
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013269transparent
13270 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13271 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13272 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13273 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13274 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13275 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13276 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13277 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13278 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13279 so check for support with your vendor.
13280
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013281v4v6
13282 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13283 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13284 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13285 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013286 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013287
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013288v6only
13289 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13290 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13291 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013292 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13293 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013294
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013295uid <uid>
13296 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13297 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13298 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13299 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13300 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13301
13302user <user>
13303 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13304 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13305 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13306 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13307 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13308
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013309verify [none|optional|required]
13310 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13311 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13312 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13313 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13314 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013315 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13316 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13317 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13318 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013319
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200133205.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013321------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013322
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013323The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13324which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13325arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13326settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13327after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13328Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13329address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013331 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013332 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013333
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013334Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13335keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13336
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013337The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013338
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013339addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013340 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013341 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13342 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13343 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13344 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13345 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013346
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013347agent-check
13348 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013349 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013350 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13351 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13352 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013353
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013354 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013355 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013356 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13357 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13358 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013360 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13361 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13362 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13363 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13364 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013365
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013366 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013367 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013368
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013369 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13370 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13371 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013372
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013373 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13374 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13375 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013376
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013377 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013378 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13379 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13380 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13381 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013382 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013383 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013384
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013385 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13386 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013387
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013388 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13389 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13390 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13391 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13392 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13393 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13394 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13395 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13396 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013397
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013398 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13399 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013400 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13401 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13402 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013403 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013404
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013405 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013406 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013407
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013408agent-send <string>
13409 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13410 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13411 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13412 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13413 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13414
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013415agent-inter <delay>
13416 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13417 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13418
13419 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13420 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13421 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13422 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13423 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13424 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13425 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13426 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13427 of backends use the same servers.
13428
13429 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13430
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013431agent-addr <addr>
13432 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13433
13434 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13435 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13436 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13437 hostname, it will be resolved.
13438
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013439agent-port <port>
13440 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13441
13442 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13443
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013444allow-0rtt
13445 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013446 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13447 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013448
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013449alpn <protocols>
13450 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13451 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13452 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013453 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013454 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13455 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13456 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13457 now obsolete NPN extension.
13458 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13459 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13460
13461 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013463backup
13464 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13465 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13466 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13467 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013468 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13469 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013470
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013471ca-file <cafile>
13472 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13473 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13474 server's certificate.
13475
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013476check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013477 This option enables health checks on a server:
13478 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13479 considered available.
13480 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13481 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13482 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13483 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13484 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13485 set.
13486 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13487 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13488 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13489 exchanges succeed.
13490
13491 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13492 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13493 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13494 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13495 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013496 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013497 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13498
13499 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13500 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13501
13502 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13503 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13504
13505 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13506 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13507 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13508 available.
13509
13510 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13511 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13512 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13513
13514 Example:
13515 # simple tcp check
13516 backend foo
13517 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13518 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13519 backend foo
13520 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13521 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13522 backend foo
13523 option tcp-check
13524 tcp-check connect
13525 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013526
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013527check-send-proxy
13528 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13529 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13530 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13531 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13532 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13533 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13534 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13535
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013536check-alpn <protocols>
13537 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13538 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13539 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13540
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013541check-proto <name>
13542 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13543 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13544 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13545 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013546 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013547 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13548 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13549
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013550check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013551 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013552 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13553 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013554
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013555check-ssl
13556 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13557 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13558 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13559 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013560 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013561 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13562 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013563 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013564 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13565 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013566
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013567check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013568 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013569 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13570 for normal traffic.
13571
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013572ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013573 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13574 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13575 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013576 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13577 information and recommendations see e.g.
13578 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13579 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13580 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013581
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013582ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13583 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13584 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13585 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13586 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013587 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13588 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13589 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013591cookie <value>
13592 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13593 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13594 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13595 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13596 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13597 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13598 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13599
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013600crl-file <crlfile>
13601 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13602 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13603 to verify server's certificate.
13604
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013605crt <cert>
13606 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13607 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13608 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13609 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13610 certificate request.
13611
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013612disabled
13613 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13614 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13615 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13616 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13617 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013618 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013619
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013620enabled
13621 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13622 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13623 default value.
13624 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13625 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013626
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013627error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013628 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13629 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13630 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013632 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013633
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013634fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013635 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13636 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13637 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13638
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013639force-sslv3
13640 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13641 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013642 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013643 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013644
13645force-tlsv10
13646 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013647 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013648 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013649
13650force-tlsv11
13651 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013652 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013653 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013654
13655force-tlsv12
13656 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013657 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013658 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013659
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013660force-tlsv13
13661 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13662 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013663 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013665id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013666 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13667 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13668 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013669
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013670init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13671 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13672 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013673 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013674 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13675 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13676 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13677 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13678 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13679 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13680 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13681 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13682 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013683 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013684 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13685 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13686 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13687 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13688 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13689 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013690 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013691
13692 Example:
13693 defaults
13694 # never fail on address resolution
13695 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13696
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013697inter <delay>
13698fastinter <delay>
13699downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013700 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13701 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13702 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13703 between checks depending on the server state :
13704
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013705 Server state | Interval used
13706 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13707 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13708 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13709 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13710 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13711 or yet unchecked. |
13712 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13713 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13714 | "inter" otherwise.
13715 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013717 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13718 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13719 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13720 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013721 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13722 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13723 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13724 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13725 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013726
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013727log-proto <logproto>
13728 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13729 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13730 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13731 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13732
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013733maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013734 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13735 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013736 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13737 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013738 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13739 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13740 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13741 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13742
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013743 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13744 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13745 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13746 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13747 than 50 concurrent requests.
13748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013749maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013750 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13751 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13752 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13753 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020013754 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
13755 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
13756 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
13757 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
13758 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
13759 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
13760 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013761
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013762max-reuse <count>
13763 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13764 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13765 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13766 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13767 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13768 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13769 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13770 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013772minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013773 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13774 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13775 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13776 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13777 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13778 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013779 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013780 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013781
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013782namespace <name>
13783 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13784 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13785 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13786 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13787
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013788no-agent-check
13789 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13790 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13791 default value.
13792 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13793 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13794
13795no-backup
13796 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13797 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13798 default value.
13799 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13800 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13801
13802no-check
13803 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13804 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13805 default value.
13806 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13807 "default-server" "check" setting.
13808
13809no-check-ssl
13810 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13811 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13812 default value.
13813 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13814 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13815
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013816no-send-proxy
13817 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13818 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13819 default value.
13820 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13821 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13822
13823no-send-proxy-v2
13824 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13825 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13826 default value.
13827 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13828 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13829
13830no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13831 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13832 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13833 default value.
13834 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13835 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13836
13837no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13838 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13839 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13840 default value.
13841 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13842 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13843
13844no-ssl
13845 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13846 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13847 default value.
13848 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13849 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13850
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010013851 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
13852 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
13853 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
13854
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013855no-ssl-reuse
13856 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13857 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13858 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13859 and for paranoid users.
13860
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013861no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013862 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13863 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013864 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013865
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013866 Supported in default-server: No
13867
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013868no-tls-tickets
13869 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13870 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13871 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013872 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13873 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013874 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13875 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13876 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013877 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013878
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013879no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013880 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013881 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13882 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013883 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13884 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013885 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013886
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013887 Supported in default-server: No
13888
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013889no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013890 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013891 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13892 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013893 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13894 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013895 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013896
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013897 Supported in default-server: No
13898
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013899no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013900 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013901 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13902 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013903 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13904 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013905 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013906
13907 Supported in default-server: No
13908
13909no-tlsv13
13910 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13911 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13912 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13913 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13914 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013915 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013916
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013917 Supported in default-server: No
13918
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013919no-verifyhost
13920 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13921 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13922 default value.
13923 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13924 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013925
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013926no-tfo
13927 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13928 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13929 default value.
13930 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13931 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13932
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013933non-stick
13934 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13935 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13936 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13937
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013938npn <protocols>
13939 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13940 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13941 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013942 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013943 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13944 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13945 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13946
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013947observe <mode>
13948 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13949 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13950 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13951 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13952 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13953 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013954 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013955
13956 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13957
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013958on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013959 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13960 Currently, four modes are available:
13961 - fastinter: force fastinter
13962 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13963 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13964 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13965 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13966
13967 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13968
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013969on-marked-down <action>
13970 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13971 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013972 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13973 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13974 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13975 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13976 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13977 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13978 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13979 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013980
13981 Actions are disabled by default
13982
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013983on-marked-up <action>
13984 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13985 Currently one action is available:
13986 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13987 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13988 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13989 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013990 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13991 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013992 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13993 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13994
13995 Actions are disabled by default
13996
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013997pool-low-conn <max>
13998 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13999 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14000 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14001 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14002 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14003 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14004 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14005 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14006 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14007 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
14008 applying to "http-reuse".
14009
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014010pool-max-conn <max>
14011 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14012 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14013 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14014 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14015 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14016 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14017
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014018pool-purge-delay <delay>
14019 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014020 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014021 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014022
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014023port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014024 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
14025 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
14026 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
14027 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
14028 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
14029 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
14030
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014031proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014032 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14033 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14034 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
14035 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014036 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014037 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14038
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014039redir <prefix>
14040 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14041 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14042 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14043 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14044 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14045 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14046 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14047 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014048 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014049 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014050 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14051 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14052 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14053 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14054
14055 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014057rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014058 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14059 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14060 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14061
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014062resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14063 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14064 server.
14065
14066 Available options:
14067
14068 * allow-dup-ip
14069 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14070 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14071 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14072 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14073 For such case, simply enable this option.
14074 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14075
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014076 * ignore-weight
14077 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14078 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14079 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14080
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014081 * prevent-dup-ip
14082 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14083 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14084 same fqdn.
14085 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14086
14087 Example:
14088 backend b_myapp
14089 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14090 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14091 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14092
14093 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14094 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14095 it
14096 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14097 different address
14098
14099 Default value: not set
14100
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014101resolve-prefer <family>
14102 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14103 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14104 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14105 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14106
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014107 Default value: ipv6
14108
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014109 Example:
14110
14111 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014112
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014113resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014114 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014115 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014116 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014117 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14118 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014119 configured network, another address is selected.
14120
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014121 Example:
14122
14123 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014124
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014125resolvers <id>
14126 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14127 hostname.
14128
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014129 Example:
14130
14131 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014132
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014133 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014134
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014135send-proxy
14136 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14137 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14138 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14139 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014140 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14141 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14142 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14143 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14144 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14145 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14146 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14147 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14148 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14149 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014150 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14151 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014152
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014153send-proxy-v2
14154 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14155 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14156 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14157 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014158 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14159 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14160 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14161 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014162
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014163proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014164 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14165 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14166
14167 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14168 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14169 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14170 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14171 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14172 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14173 connection is supported).
14174 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14175 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14176 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14177 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14178 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14179 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14180 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014181
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014182send-proxy-v2-ssl
14183 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14184 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14185 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14186 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14187 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14188 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14189 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014190 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14191 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014192
14193send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14194 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14195 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14196 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14197 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14198 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14199 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14200 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14201 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014202 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14203 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014204
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014205slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014206 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14207 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14208 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14209 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14210 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14211 parameters :
14212
14213 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14214 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14215
14216 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14217 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14218 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14219 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14220
14221 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14222 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14223 seen as failed.
14224
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014225sni <expression>
14226 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14227 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14228 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14229 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014230 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14231 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014232 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014233 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14234 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014235
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014236source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014237source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014238source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014239 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14240 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14241 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14242 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14243
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014244 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14245 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14246 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14247 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14248 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14249 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14250 server.
14251
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014252 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14253 specifying the source address without port(s).
14254
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014255ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014256 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14257 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14258 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14259 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14260 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14261 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014262 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14263 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014264
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014265ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14266 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14267 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14268 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14269
14270ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14271 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14272 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14273 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14274
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014275ssl-reuse
14276 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14277 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14278 default value.
14279 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14280 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14281
14282stick
14283 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14284 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14285 default value.
14286 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14287 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014288
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014289socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014290 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014291 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14292 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14293
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014294tcp-ut <delay>
14295 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14296 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14297 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014298 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014299 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14300 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14301 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14302 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14303 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14304 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14305 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14306 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14307 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14308
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014309tfo
14310 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14311 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14312 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14313 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14314 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014315 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014317track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014318 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14319 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14320 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14321 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014322 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14323
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014324tls-tickets
14325 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14326 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14327 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014328 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14329 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14330 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014331 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014332 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014333
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014334verify [none|required]
14335 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014336 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014337 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14338 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014339 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014340 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14341 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14342 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14343 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14344 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14345 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14346 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14347 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014348
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014349verifyhost <hostname>
14350 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014351 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14352 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14353 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14354 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14355 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14356 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14357 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14358 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014359
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014360weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014361 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14362 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14363 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014364 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14365 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14366 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14367 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14368 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14369 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014370
14371
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143725.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14373-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014374
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014375HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14376using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
14377configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014378This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14379can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14380workload.
14381This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14382resolution at run time.
14383Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14384carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14385
14386
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143875.3.1. Global overview
14388----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014389
14390As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14391different steps of the process life:
14392
14393 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14394 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14395 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14396
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014397 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14398 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014399
14400A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14401 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14402 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14403 resolution to know this new IP.
14404
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014405When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014406HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014407SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14408from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14409will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14410will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014411
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014412A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014413 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014414 first valid response.
14415
14416 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14417 servers return an error.
14418
14419
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200144205.3.2. The resolvers section
14421----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014422
14423This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014424HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14425contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014426
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014427When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14428uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14429is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14430answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14431
14432When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014433used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014434
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014435 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14436 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14437 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014438
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014439 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14440 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014441
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014442 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14443 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14444 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014445
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014446For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14447following scenarios are possible:
14448
14449 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14450 ignored
14451
14452 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14453 applied
14454
14455 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14456 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14457
14458 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14459 retries the query with a new type
14460
14461 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14462 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014463
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014464As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14465a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014466<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014467
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014468
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014469resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014470 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014471
14472A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14473
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014474accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014475 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014476 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014477 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14478 by RFC 6891)
14479
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014480 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14481
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014482nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14483 DNS server description:
14484 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14485 <ip> : IP address of the server
14486 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14487
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014488parse-resolv-conf
14489 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14490 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14491 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14492
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014493hold <status> <period>
14494 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14495 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014496 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014497 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014498 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14499 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14500 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14501
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014502 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014503
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014504resolve_retries <nb>
14505 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14506 giving up.
14507 Default value: 3
14508
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014509 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14510 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14511 type.
14512
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014513timeout <event> <time>
14514 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14515 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14516 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014517 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14518 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014519 Default value: 1s
14520 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014521 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014522 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014523 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14524 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14525
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014526 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014527
14528 resolvers mydns
14529 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14530 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014531 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014532 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014533 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014534 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014535 hold other 30s
14536 hold refused 30s
14537 hold nx 30s
14538 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014539 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014540 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014541
14542
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200145436. Cache
14544---------
14545
14546HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14547(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14548RAM.
14549
14550The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14551this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14552
14553If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14554independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14555when we try to allocate a new one.
14556
14557The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14558
14559It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14560"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14561for more details.
14562
14563When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14564replaced by "<CACHE>".
14565
14566
145676.1. Limitation
14568----------------
14569
14570The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14571
14572- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010014573- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
14574 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
14575 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014576- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14577- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010014578- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
14579 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
14580 headers)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014581
14582- If the request is not a GET
14583- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14584- If the request contains an Authorization header
14585
14586
145876.2. Setup
14588-----------
14589
14590To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14591the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14592
14593
145946.2.1. Cache section
14595---------------------
14596
14597cache <name>
14598 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14599 size of cache is mandatory.
14600
14601total-max-size <megabytes>
14602 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14603 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14604
14605max-object-size <bytes>
14606 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14607 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14608 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14609
14610max-age <seconds>
14611 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14612 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14613 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14614 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14615 default.
14616
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010014617process-vary <0 or 1>
14618 Disable or enable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
14619 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
14620 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
14621 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
14622 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is 0 (disabled).
14623
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014624
146256.2.2. Proxy section
14626---------------------
14627
14628http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14629 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14630 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14631 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14632 after this one.
14633
14634http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14635 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14636 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14637 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14638 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14639
14640
14641Example:
14642
14643 backend bck1
14644 mode http
14645
14646 http-request cache-use foobar
14647 http-response cache-store foobar
14648 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14649
14650 cache foobar
14651 total-max-size 4
14652 max-age 240
14653
14654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146557. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14656----------------------------------
14657
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014658HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014659client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14660The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14661these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14662but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14663data called patterns.
14664
14665
146667.1. ACL basics
14667---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014668
14669The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14670content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14671from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14672simple :
14673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014674 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014675 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014676 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14677 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014679The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14680adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014681
14682In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014684 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014685
14686This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14687Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14688and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014689an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14690conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14691as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14692are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014693
14694ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14695'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14696which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14697
14698There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14699performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014701The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14702specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14703this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014704methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14705ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014706
14707Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14708 - boolean
14709 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14710 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14711 - string
14712 - data block
14713
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014714Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14715converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14716would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14717The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14718which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14719
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014720Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14721keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14722fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14723which are summarized in the table below :
14724
14725 +---------------------+-----------------+
14726 | Sample or converter | Default |
14727 | output type | matching method |
14728 +---------------------+-----------------+
14729 | boolean | bool |
14730 +---------------------+-----------------+
14731 | integer | int |
14732 +---------------------+-----------------+
14733 | ip | ip |
14734 +---------------------+-----------------+
14735 | string | str |
14736 +---------------------+-----------------+
14737 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14738 +---------------------+-----------------+
14739
14740Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14741matching method, see below.
14742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014743The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14744 - boolean
14745 - integer or integer range
14746 - IP address / network
14747 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14748 - regular expression
14749 - hex block
14750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014751The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14752
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014753 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14754 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014755 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014756 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014757 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014758 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014759 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014761The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14762read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14763if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14764lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14765will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14766beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14767a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14768lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14769exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14770
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014771The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14772parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14773ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14774a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14775check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14776
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014777The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14778socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14779file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014781Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14782loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14783
14784 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14785
14786In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14787the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14788case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14789as well.
14790
14791The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14792sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14793do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14794methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14795is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014796obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014797followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14798default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14799that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14800string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14801
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014802The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14803By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14804string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14805resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14806server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014807waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014808flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14809function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014811There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14812sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14813be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014814
14815 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14816 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014817 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14818 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14819 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14820 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014821
14822 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14823 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014824 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014825
14826 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014827 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014828
14829 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014830 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014831
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014832 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014833 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14834
14835 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14836 binary or string samples.
14837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014838 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14839 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014841 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14842 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14843 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014845 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14846 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014848 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14849 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014851 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14852 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014854 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14855 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014856 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014858 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14859 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14860 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014861
14862For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14863request, it is possible to do :
14864
14865 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14866
14867In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14868buffer, one would use the following acl :
14869
14870 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14871
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014872On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14873possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14874
14875 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014877All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14878criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14879method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14880to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14881criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14882the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014884If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014885the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14886For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014888 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14889 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14890 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14891 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014892
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014893
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014894The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14895types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14896combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14897brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14898default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014900 +-------------------------------------------------+
14901 | Input sample type |
14902 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014903 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014904 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14905 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14906 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014907 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014908 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014909 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014910 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014911 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014912 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014913 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014914 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014915 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014916 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014917 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014918 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014919 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014920 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014921 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014922 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014923 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014924 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014925 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014926 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014927 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014928 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14929 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14930 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014931
14932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149337.1.1. Matching booleans
14934------------------------
14935
14936In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14937Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14938When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14939that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14940
14941Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14942return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14943"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14944
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149467.1.2. Matching integers
14947------------------------
14948
14949Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14950enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14951to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14952
14953Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14954matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14955lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014956
14957For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14958unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14959representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14960
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014961As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14962two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14963instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14964ranges and operators.
14965
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014966For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014967operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14968Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14969of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014970
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014971Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014972
14973 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14974 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14975 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14976 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14977 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14978
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014979For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014980
14981 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14982
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014983This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14984
14985 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14986
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149887.1.3. Matching strings
14989-----------------------
14990
14991String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14992different forms :
14993
14994 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014995 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014996
14997 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014998 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014999
15000 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15001 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15002
15003 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15004 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15005
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015006 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015007 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15008 matches.
15009
15010 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15011 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15012 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015013
15014String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15015exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15016characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15017string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15018to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015019before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015020
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015021Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15022(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15023Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15024
15025Example:
15026 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15027 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15028
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150307.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15031---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015032
15033Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15034they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15035possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15036passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15037the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015038the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15039match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015040
15041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150427.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15043-------------------------------------
15044
15045It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15046not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15047a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15048to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15049digits may be used upper or lower case.
15050
15051Example :
15052 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15053 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15054
15055
150567.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15057---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015058
15059IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15060netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15061within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015062host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015063difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15064at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15065does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15066parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015067
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015068The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15069abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15070
15071 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15072 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15073 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15074 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15075 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15076 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15077 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15078 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15079
15080Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15081192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15082
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015083IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15084Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15085trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15086IPv6 patterns.
15087
15088HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15089following situations :
15090 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15091 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15092 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15093 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15094 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15095 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15096 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15097 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15098 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15099 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015101
151027.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15103----------------------------------
15104
15105Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15106combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15107
15108 - AND (implicit)
15109 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15110 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015112A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015114 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015116Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15117indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015119For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15120"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15121requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15122is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15123
15124 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015125 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15126 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15127 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015128
15129To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15130and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15131
15132 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15133 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15134 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15135 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15136
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015137 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015138 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15139 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15140 use_backend www if host_www
15141
15142It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15143expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15144be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15145the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15146
15147 The following rule :
15148
15149 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015150 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015151
15152 Can also be written that way :
15153
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015154 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015155
15156It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15157to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15158simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15159sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15160good use is the following :
15161
15162 With named ACLs :
15163
15164 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15165 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15166 monitor fail if site_dead
15167
15168 With anonymous ACLs :
15169
15170 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15171
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015172See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15173keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015174
15175
151767.3. Fetching samples
15177---------------------
15178
15179Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15180against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15181sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15182ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15183of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15184available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15185
15186This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15187Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15188compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15189deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15190
15191The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15192matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15193method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15194indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15195
15196As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15197when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15198mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15199the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15200ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15201
15202Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15203multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15204when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015205incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15206are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015207is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15208all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15209
15210Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15211 - name
15212 - name(arg1)
15213 - name(arg1,arg2)
15214
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015215
152167.3.1. Converters
15217-----------------
15218
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015219Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15220of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15221is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15222was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015223has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015224unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15225
15226These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15227sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15228the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015229support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015230
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015231A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15232support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15233supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15234(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15235bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015237The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015238
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001523951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15240 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15241 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15242 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15243 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15244 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15245
15246 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015247 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15248 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015249 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15250 frontend http-in
15251 bind *:8081
15252 default_backend servers
15253 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15254 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15255
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015256add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015257 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015258 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015259 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15260 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015261 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015262 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15263 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15264 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15265 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015266 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015267 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015268
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015269aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15270 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15271 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15272 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15273 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15274 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15275 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15276
15277 Example:
15278 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15279 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15280
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015281and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015282 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015283 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015284 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15285 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015286 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015287 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15288 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15289 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15290 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015291 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015292 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015293
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015294b64dec
15295 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15296 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
15297
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015298base64
15299 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015300 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015301 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
15302
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015303bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015304 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015305 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015306 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015307 presence of a flag).
15308
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015309bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15310 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15311 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015312 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015313
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015314concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15315 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15316 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15317 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15318 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15319 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15320 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15321 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15322 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15323 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15324 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015325 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015326 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015327 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15328 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015329
15330 Example:
15331 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15332 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15333 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015334 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015335 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15336
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015337cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015338 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15339 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015340
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015341crc32([<avalanche>])
15342 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15343 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15344 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15345 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15346 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15347 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15348 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15349 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15350 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15351 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015352 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15353
15354crc32c([<avalanche>])
15355 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15356 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15357 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15358 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15359 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15360 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15361 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15362 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015363
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015364cut_crlf
15365 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15366 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15367 updated.
15368
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015369da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015370 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15371 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15372 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15373 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015374 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015375 configuration language.
15376
15377 Example:
15378 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015379 bind *:8881
15380 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015381 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015382
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015383debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15384 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15385 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15386 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15387 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15388 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15389 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15390 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15391 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15392 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15393 printable sample types.
15394
15395 Example:
15396 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015397
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015398digest(<algorithm>)
15399 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15400 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15401
15402 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15403 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15404
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015405div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015406 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15407 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015408 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015409 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15410 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015411 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015412 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15413 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15414 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15415 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015416 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015417 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015418
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015419djb2([<avalanche>])
15420 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15421 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15422 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15423 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15424 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15425 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15426 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015427 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15428 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015429
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015430even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015431 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015432 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15433
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015434field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15435 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15436 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15437 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15438 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15439 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15440 fields.
15441
15442 Example :
15443 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15444 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15445 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15446 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15447 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015448
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015449fix_is_valid
15450 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
15451 Information eXchange):
15452
15453 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
15454 numeric
15455 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valide FIX version
15456 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
15457 - checks the MstType tag is the third tag.
15458 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
15459 checksum
15460
15461 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15462 the server can be parsed.
15463
15464 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
15465 message, false if not.
15466
15467 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
15468
15469 Example:
15470 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15471 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15472
15473fix_tag_value(<tag>)
15474 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
15475 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
15476 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
15477 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
15478 MsgType, SenderComID, TargetComID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
15479 added.
15480
15481 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15482 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
15483 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
15484 fix_is_valid converter.
15485
15486 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
15487
15488 Example:
15489 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15490 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15491 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
15492 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
15493 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
15494
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015495hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015496 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015497 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015498 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015499 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015500
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015501hex2i
15502 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015503 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015504
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015505htonl
15506 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15507 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15508 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15509 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15510
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015511hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15512 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15513 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15514 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15515 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15516
15517 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15518 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15519
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015520http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015521 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15522 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015523 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15524 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15525 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15526 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15527 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15528 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15529 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15530 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015531
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015532iif(<true>,<false>)
15533 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15534 string otherwise.
15535
15536 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015537 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015538
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015539in_table(<table>)
15540 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15541 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15542 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015543 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015544 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15545
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015546ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15547 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015548 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015549 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15550 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15551 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15552 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15553 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015554
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015555json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015556 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015557 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015558 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015559 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15560 of errors:
15561 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15562 bytes, ...)
15563 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15564 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15565
15566 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15567 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15568 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15569 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15570 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15571 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015572 - "ascii" : never fails;
15573 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15574 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015575 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015576 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015577 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15578 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15579
15580 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015581 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015582
15583 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015584 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015585 capture request header user-agent len 150
15586 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015587
15588 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15589 GET / HTTP/1.0
15590 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15591
15592 Output log:
15593 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15594
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015595language(<value>[,<default>])
15596 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15597 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15598 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15599 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15600 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15601 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15602 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15603 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15604 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015605 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015606 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15607 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015608
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015609 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015610
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015611 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15612 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015613
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015614 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15615 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15616 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15617 use_backend spanish if es
15618 use_backend french if fr
15619 use_backend english if en
15620 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015621
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015622length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015623 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15624 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15625 type. The result is of type integer.
15626
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015627lower
15628 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15629 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15630 type. The result is of type string.
15631
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015632ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15633 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15634 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15635 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15636 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15637 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15638 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15639
15640 Example :
15641
15642 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015643 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015644 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15645
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015646ltrim(<chars>)
15647 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15648 representation of the input sample.
15649
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015650map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15651map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15652map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15653 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15654 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15655 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15656 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15657 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15658 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15659 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15660 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015661
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015662 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15663 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15664 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015665
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015666 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015667 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015668
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015669 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15670 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15671 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15672 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015673 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15674 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015675 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15676 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15677 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15678 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15679 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15680 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15681 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15682 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015683 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15684 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15685 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015686 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15687 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15688 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15689 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15690 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015691
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015692 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15693 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15694 the corresponding match text.
15695
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015696 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15697 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15698 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15699 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15700 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015701
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015702 Example :
15703
15704 # this is a comment and is ignored
15705 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15706 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15707 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15708 | | | `---------- value
15709 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15710 | `---------------------------- key
15711 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15712
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015713mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015714 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15715 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015716 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015717 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015718 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015719 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15720 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15721 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15722 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015723 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015724 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015725
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010015726mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname or property ID>)
15727 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
15728 <packettype>.
15729 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
15730 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
15731 from.
15732 Supported string and integers can be found here:
15733 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
15734 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
15735
15736 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
15737 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
15738 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
15739 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
15740
15741 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
15742 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
15743 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15744 packets only):
15745 17: Session Expiry Interval
15746 33: Receive Maximum
15747 39: Maximum Packet Size
15748 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15749 25: Request Response Information
15750 23: Request Problem Information
15751 21: Authentication Method
15752 22: Authentication Data
15753 18: Will Delay Interval
15754 1: Payload Format Indicator
15755 2: Message Expiry Interval
15756 3: Content Type
15757 8: Response Topic
15758 9: Correlation Data
15759 Not supported yet:
15760 38: User Property
15761
15762 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
15763 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15764 packets only):
15765 17: Session Expiry Interval
15766 33: Receive Maximum
15767 36: Maximum QoS
15768 37: Retain Available
15769 39: Maximum Packet Size
15770 18: Assigned Client Identifier
15771 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15772 31: Reason String
15773 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
15774 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
15775 42: Shared Subscription Available
15776 19: Server Keep Alive
15777 26: Response Information
15778 28: Server Reference
15779 21: Authentication Method
15780 22: Authentication Data
15781 Not supported yet:
15782 38: User Property
15783
15784 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15785 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15786 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15787 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15788
15789 Example:
15790
15791 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15792 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15793 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
15794 if data_in_buffer
15795 # do the same as above
15796 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15797 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
15798 if data_in_buffer
15799
15800mqtt_is_valid
15801 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
15802
15803 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15804 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15805 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15806 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15807
15808 Example:
15809
15810 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15811 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
15812
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015813mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015814 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015815 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15816 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015817 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015818 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015819 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015820 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15821 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15822 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15823 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015824 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015825 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015826
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015827nbsrv
15828 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15829 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15830 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15831 map lookup.
15832
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015833neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015834 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15835 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15836 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15837 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015838
15839not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015840 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015841 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015842 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015843 absence of a flag).
15844
15845odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015846 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015847 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15848
15849or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015850 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015851 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015852 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15853 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015854 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015855 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15856 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15857 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15858 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015859 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015860 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015861
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015862protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15863 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15864 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15865 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15866 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15867 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15868 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15869 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15870 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15871 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15872 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15873 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15874
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015875regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015876 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15877 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15878 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15879 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15880 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15881 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15882 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15883 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15884 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015885 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15886 of characters with other ones.
15887
15888 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15889 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15890 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15891 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15892 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15893 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015894
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015895 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015896
15897 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15898 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15899 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015900 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015901
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015902 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15903 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15904
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015905 # capture groups and backreferences
15906 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020015907 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015908 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15909
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015910capture-req(<id>)
15911 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15912 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15913
15914 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015915 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15916 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015917
15918capture-res(<id>)
15919 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15920 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15921
15922 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015923 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15924 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015925
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015926rtrim(<chars>)
15927 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15928 of the input sample.
15929
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015930sdbm([<avalanche>])
15931 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15932 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15933 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15934 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15935 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15936 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15937 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015938 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15939 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015940
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015941secure_memcmp(<var>)
15942 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15943 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15944 match.
15945
15946 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15947 performed in constant time.
15948
15949 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15950 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15951
15952 Example :
15953
15954 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15955 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15956 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15957 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15958
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015959set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015960 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15961 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15962 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015963 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015964 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15965 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015966 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015967 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15968 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015969 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015970 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015971
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015972sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015973 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015974 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15975
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015976sha2([<bits>])
15977 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15978 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15979
15980 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15981 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15982
15983 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15984 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15985
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015986srv_queue
15987 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15988 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15989 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15990 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15991 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15992
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015993strcmp(<var>)
15994 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15995 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15996 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15997 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15998 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15999 shorter).
16000
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016001 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16002 strings in constant time.
16003
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016004 Example :
16005
16006 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16007 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16008 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16009
16010
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016011sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016012 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16013 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016014 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016015 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16016 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016017 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016018 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16019 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016020 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016021 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16022 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016023 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016024 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016025
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016026table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16027 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16028 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16029 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16030 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16031 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16032 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16033
16034
16035table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16036 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16037 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16038 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16039 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16040 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16041 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16042
16043table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16044 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16045 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016046 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016047 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16048 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16049
16050table_conn_cur(<table>)
16051 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16052 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16053 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16054 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16055 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16056
16057table_conn_rate(<table>)
16058 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16059 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16060 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16061 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16062 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16063
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016064table_gpt0(<table>)
16065 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16066 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16067 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16068 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16069 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16070
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016071table_gpc0(<table>)
16072 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16073 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16074 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16075 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16076 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16077
16078table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16079 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16080 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16081 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16082 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16083 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16084 sample fetch keyword.
16085
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016086table_gpc1(<table>)
16087 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16088 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16089 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16090 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16091 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16092
16093table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16094 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16095 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16096 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16097 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16098 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16099 sample fetch keyword.
16100
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016101table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16102 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16103 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016104 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016105 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16106 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16107
16108table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16109 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16110 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16111 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16112 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16113 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16114 keyword.
16115
16116table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16117 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16118 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016119 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016120 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16121 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16122
16123table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16124 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16125 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16126 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16127 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16128 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16129 keyword.
16130
16131table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16132 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16133 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016134 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016135 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16136 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16137 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16138 keyword.
16139
16140table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16141 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16142 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016143 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016144 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16145 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16146 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16147 keyword.
16148
16149table_server_id(<table>)
16150 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16151 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16152 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16153 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16154 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16155 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16156
16157table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16158 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16159 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016160 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016161 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16162 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16163 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16164 keyword.
16165
16166table_sess_rate(<table>)
16167 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16168 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16169 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16170 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16171 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16172 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16173 keyword.
16174
16175table_trackers(<table>)
16176 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16177 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16178 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16179 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16180 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16181 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16182 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16183 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16184 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16185 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16186
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016187upper
16188 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16189 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16190 type. The result is of type string.
16191
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016192url_dec([<in_form>])
16193 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16194 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16195 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16196 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16197 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16198 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016199
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016200ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016201 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016202 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16203 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16204 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016205 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16206 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16207 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16208 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016209 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016210 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16211 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016212
16213 Example:
16214 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16215 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16216
16217 message Point {
16218 int32 latitude = 1;
16219 int32 longitude = 2;
16220 }
16221
16222 message PPoint {
16223 Point point = 59;
16224 }
16225
16226 message Rectangle {
16227 // One corner of the rectangle.
16228 PPoint lo = 48;
16229 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16230 PPoint hi = 49;
16231 }
16232
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016233 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16234 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16235 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016236
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016237 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16238 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016239 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016240 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16241
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016242 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016243
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016244 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016245
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016246 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16247 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16248 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016249
16250 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16251 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16252 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16253
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016254 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16255 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16256 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016257
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016258
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016259unset-var(<var name>)
16260 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16261 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16262 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16263 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16264 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16265 response),
16266 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16267 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16268 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16269 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16270
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016271utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16272 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16273 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16274 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16275 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16276 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16277 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16278
16279 Example :
16280
16281 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016282 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016283 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16284
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016285word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16286 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16287 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16288 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016289 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016290 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16291 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16292
16293 Example :
16294 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16295 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16296 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16297 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16298 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016299 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016300
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016301wt6([<avalanche>])
16302 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16303 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16304 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16305 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16306 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16307 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16308 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016309 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16310 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016311
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016312xor(<value>)
16313 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016314 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016315 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016316 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016317 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016318 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16319 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016320 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016321 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16322 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016323 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016324 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016325
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016326xxh32([<seed>])
16327 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16328 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16329 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16330 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16331 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16332 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16333 as cryptographically secure.
16334
16335xxh64([<seed>])
16336 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16337 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16338 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16339 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16340 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16341 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16342 as cryptographically secure.
16343
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016344
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163457.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016346--------------------------------------------
16347
16348A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16349not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16350"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16351The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16352
16353always_false : boolean
16354 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16355 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16356
16357always_true : boolean
16358 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16359 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16360
16361avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016362 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016363 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16364 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16365 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16366 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16367 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16368 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16369 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16370 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16371 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16372 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16373 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16374 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16375 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016377be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016378 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16379 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16380 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16381 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016382 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16383
16384be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16385 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16386 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16387 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16388 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16389 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016390 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16391 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016392
16393 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16394 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16395 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016397be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16398 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16399 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16400 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016401 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016402 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16403 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016404
16405 Example :
16406 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16407 backend dynamic
16408 mode http
16409 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16410 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016411
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016412bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016413 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16414 of the string.
16415
16416bool(<bool>) : bool
16417 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16418 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016420connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16421 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016422 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016423 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16424 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016425
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016426 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016427 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016428 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16429
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016430 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16431 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016432
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016433 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016434 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016435 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016436 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016437 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016438 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016439 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016440
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016441 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16442 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016443 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016444 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016445
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016446cpu_calls : integer
16447 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16448 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16449 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16450 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16451 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16452 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16453
16454cpu_ns_avg : integer
16455 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16456 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16457 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16458 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16459 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16460 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16461 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16462 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16463 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16464 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16465 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16466
16467cpu_ns_tot : integer
16468 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16469 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16470 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16471 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16472 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16473 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16474 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16475 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16476 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16477 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16478 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16479 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16480 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16481
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016482date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016483 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016484
16485 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16486 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16487 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016488 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16489
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016490 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16491 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16492 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16493 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16494 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16495
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016496 Example :
16497
16498 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16499 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016500
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016501 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16502 # millisecond granularity
16503 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16504
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016505date_us : integer
16506 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16507 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16508 from the same timeval structure.
16509
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016510distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16511 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16512 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16513 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16514 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16515 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16516 list of supported tokens.
16517
16518distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16519 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16520 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16521 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16522 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16523 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16524 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16525 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16526 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16527 supported tokens.
16528
16529 Example :
16530 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16531 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16532 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16533 # send large files to the big farm
16534 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16535
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016536env(<name>) : string
16537 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16538 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16539 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16540 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16541 certain way.
16542
16543 Examples :
16544 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16545 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16546
16547 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16548 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016550fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16551 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016552 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16553 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016554 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16555 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016556 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016557 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16558 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016559
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016560fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16561 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16562 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16563 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016565fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16566 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16567 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16568 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16569 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16570 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16571 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16572 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16573 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016574
16575 Example :
16576 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16577 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16578 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16579 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16580 frontend mail
16581 bind :25
16582 mode tcp
16583 maxconn 100
16584 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16585 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16586 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16587 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016588
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016589hostname : string
16590 Returns the system hostname.
16591
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016592int(<integer>) : signed integer
16593 Returns a signed integer.
16594
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016595ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16596 Returns an ipv4.
16597
16598ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16599 Returns an ipv6.
16600
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016601lat_ns_avg : integer
16602 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16603 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16604 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16605 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16606 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16607 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16608 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16609 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16610 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016611 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16612 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16613 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16614 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16615 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16616 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016617
16618lat_ns_tot : integer
16619 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16620 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16621 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16622 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16623 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16624 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16625 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16626 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16627 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016628 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16629 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16630 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16631 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16632 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016633 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16634 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16635 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16636 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16637 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16638 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16639
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016640meth(<method>) : method
16641 Returns a method.
16642
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016643nbproc : integer
16644 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16645 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16646 and debugging purposes.
16647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016648nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16649 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16650 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16651 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016652 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16653 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16654 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016655
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016656prio_class : integer
16657 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16658 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16659 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16660
16661prio_offset : integer
16662 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16663 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16664 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16665 set-priority-offset".
16666
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016667proc : integer
16668 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16669 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16670 debugging purposes.
16671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016672queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016673 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16674 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16675 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016676 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16677 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16678 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16679 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16680 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16681
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016682rand([<range>]) : integer
16683 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16684 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16685 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16686 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16687 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16688
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016689uuid([<version>]) : string
16690 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16691 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16692 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016694srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16695 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16696 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16697 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16698 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16699 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016700 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16701 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16702
16703srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16704 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16705 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16706 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16707 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16708 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16709 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16710 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16711
16712 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16713 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016714
16715srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16716 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16717 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16718 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016719 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016720 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16721 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16722 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16723
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016724srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16725 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16726 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16727 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16728 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16729 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16730 fetch methods.
16731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016732srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16733 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16734 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016735 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016736 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16737 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016738 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016739 overloading servers).
16740
16741 Example :
16742 # Redirect to a separate back
16743 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16744 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16745 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16746
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016747srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16748 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16749 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16750 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16751
16752srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16753 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16754 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16755 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16756
16757srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16758 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16759 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16760 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16761
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016762stopping : boolean
16763 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16764 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16765 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16766
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016767str(<string>) : string
16768 Returns a string.
16769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016770table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16771 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16772 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16773
16774table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16775 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16776 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16777 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16778
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016779thread : integer
16780 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16781 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16782 and debugging purposes.
16783
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016784var(<var-name>) : undefined
16785 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016786 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16787 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016788 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016789 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16790 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016791 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016792 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16793 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016794 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016795 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016796
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200167977.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016798----------------------------------
16799
16800The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16801closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16802methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16803sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16804TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016805the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16806counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016807"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16808used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16809can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16810Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16811table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16812tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16813currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016814
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016815bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016816 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16817 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16818 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016820be_id : integer
16821 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016822 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16823 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016824
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016825be_name : string
16826 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016827 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16828 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016830dst : ip
16831 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16832 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16833 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16834 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016835 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16836 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16837 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16838 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16839 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16840 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016841
16842dst_conn : integer
16843 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16844 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16845 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16846 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16847 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16848 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16849 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16850 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016851
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016852dst_is_local : boolean
16853 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16854 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16855 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16856 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016857 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016858 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16859 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16860 it only once per connection.
16861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016862dst_port : integer
16863 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16864 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16865 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16866 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16867 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16868 an HTTP header.
16869
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016870fc_http_major : integer
16871 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16872 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16873 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16874
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016875fc_pp_authority : string
16876 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16877 if any.
16878
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016879fc_pp_unique_id : string
16880 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16881 if any.
16882
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016883fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16884 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16885 header.
16886
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016887fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16888 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16889 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16890 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16891 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16892 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16893 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16894
16895fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16896 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16897 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16898 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16899 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16900 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16901 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16902
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016903fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016904 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16905 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16906 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16907 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16908
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016909fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016910 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16911 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16912 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16913 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16914
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016915fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016916 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16917 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16918 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16919 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16920
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016921fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016922 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16923 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16924 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16925 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16926
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016927fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016928 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16929 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16930 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16931 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16932
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016933fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016934 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16935 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16936 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16937 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16938
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016939fe_defbe : string
16940 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16941 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016943fe_id : integer
16944 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016945 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016946 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16947
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016948fe_name : string
16949 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16950 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16951 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16952
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016953sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016954sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16955sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16956sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016957 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16958 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16959 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16960
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016961sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016962sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16963sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16964sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016965 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16966 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16967 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16968
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016969sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016970sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16971sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16972sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016973 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16974 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016975 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16976 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16977 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016978
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016979 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016980 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16981 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016982 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16983 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16984 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016985 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16986 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16987
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016988sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16989sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16990sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16991sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16992 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16993 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16994 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16995 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16996 when a first ACL was verified.
16997
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016998sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016999sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17000sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17001sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017002 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017003 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17004
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017005sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017006sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17007sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17008sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017009 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17010 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17011 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17012
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017013sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017014sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17015sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17016sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017017 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17018 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17019 See also src_conn_rate.
17020
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017021sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017022sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17023sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17024sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017025 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017026 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017027
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017028sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17029sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17030sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17031sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17032 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17033 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17034
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017035sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17036sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17037sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17038sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17039 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17040 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17041
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017042sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017043sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17044sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17045sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017046 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17047 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17048 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017049 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17050 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17051 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017052
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017053sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17054sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17055sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17056sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17057 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17058 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17059 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17060 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17061 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17062 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17063
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017064sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017065sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17066sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17067sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017068 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017069 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17070 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17071
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017072sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017073sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17074sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17075sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017076 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17077 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17078 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17079 src_http_err_rate.
17080
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017081sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017082sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17083sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17084sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017085 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017086 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17087 src_http_req_cnt.
17088
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017089sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017090sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17091sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17092sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017093 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17094 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17095 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17096 src_http_req_rate.
17097
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017098sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017099sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17100sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17101sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017102 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017103 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17104 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17105 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17106 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017107
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017108 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017109 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17110 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017111 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17112
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017113sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17114sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17115sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17116sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17117 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17118 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17119 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17120 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17121 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17122
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017123sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017124sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17125sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17126sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017127 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17128 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17129 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017130
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017131sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017132sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17133sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17134sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017135 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17136 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17137 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017138
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017139sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017140sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17141sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17142sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017143 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017144 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17145 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17146 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017147 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017148 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17149
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017150sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017151sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17152sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17153sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017154 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17155 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17156 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17157 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17158 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017159 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017160
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017161sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017162sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17163sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17164sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017165 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17166 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17167 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17168
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017169sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017170sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17171sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17172sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017173 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17174 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017175 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017176 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17177 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017178 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17179 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17180 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017182so_id : integer
17183 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17184 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17185 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017186
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017187so_name : string
17188 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17189 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17190 strings instead of integers.
17191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017192src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017193 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017194 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17195 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17196 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017197 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17198 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17199 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017200 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17201 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17202 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17203 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17204 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17205 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17206 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017207
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017208 Example:
17209 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17210 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017212src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17213 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17214 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17215 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017216 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017218src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17219 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17220 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017221 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017222 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017224src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17225 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17226 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17227 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17228 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17229 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17230 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017231
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017232 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017233 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17234 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17235 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17236 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017237 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017238 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17239 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17240
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017241src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17242 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17243 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17244 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17245 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17246 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17247 was verified.
17248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017249src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017250 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017251 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017252 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017253 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017255src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017256 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017257 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17258 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017259 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017261src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17262 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17263 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17264 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017265 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017267src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017268 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017269 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017270 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017271 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017272
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017273src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17274 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17275 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17276 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17277 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17278
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017279src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17280 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17281 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17282 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17283 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017285src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017286 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017287 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017288 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17289 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017290 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17291 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17292 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017293
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017294src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17295 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17296 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17297 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17298 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17299 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17300 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17301 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017303src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017304 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017305 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017306 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017307 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017308 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017310src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17311 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17312 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17313 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17314 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017315 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017317src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017318 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017319 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17320 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017321 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017323src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17324 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17325 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17326 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017327 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017328 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017330src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17331 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17332 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17333 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017334 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017335 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17336 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017337
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017338 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017339 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017340 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017341 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017342
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017343src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17344 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17345 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17346 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17347 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17348 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17349 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17350
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017351src_is_local : boolean
17352 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17353 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17354 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17355 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017356 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017357 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17358 once per connection.
17359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017360src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017361 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17362 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17363 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17364 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17365 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017367src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017368 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17369 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17370 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17371 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17372 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017374src_port : integer
17375 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17376 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17377 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17378 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017380src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017381 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017382 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17383 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17384 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017385 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017387src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17388 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17389 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17390 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17391 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017392 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017394src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17395 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17396 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17397 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17398 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17399 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17400 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17401 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17402 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017403
17404 Example :
17405 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17406 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17407 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17408 listen ssh
17409 bind :22
17410 mode tcp
17411 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017412 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017413 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017414 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017416srv_id : integer
17417 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17418 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017419 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017420
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017421srv_name : string
17422 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17423 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017424 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017425
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200174267.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017427----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017429The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17430closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17431when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17432usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017433future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017434
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001743551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17436 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17437 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17438 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17439 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17440 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17441
17442 Example :
17443 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17444 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17445 # the request.
17446 frontend http-in
17447 bind *:8081
17448 default_backend servers
17449 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17450 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17451
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017452ssl_bc : boolean
17453 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17454 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017455 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17456 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017457
17458ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17459 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017460 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17461 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017462
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017463ssl_bc_alpn : string
17464 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17465 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017466 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017467 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17468 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17469 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17470 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17471 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017472 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17473 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017474
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017475ssl_bc_cipher : string
17476 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017477 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17478 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017479
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017480ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17481 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17482 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17483 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017484 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017485
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017486ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17487 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17488 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017489 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17490 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017491
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017492ssl_bc_npn : string
17493 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17494 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017495 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017496 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17497 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17498 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17499 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017500 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17501 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017502
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017503ssl_bc_protocol : string
17504 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017505 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17506 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017507
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017508ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017509 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017510 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017511 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17512 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017513
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017514ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17515 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17516 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17517 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017518 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017519
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017520ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17521 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17522 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017523 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17524 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017525
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017526ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17527 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17528 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17529 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017530 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017531
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017532ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17533 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017534 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17535 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017537ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17538 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17539 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17540 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17541 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17542 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017544ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17545 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17546 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17547 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17548 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017549
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017550ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017551 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17552 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17553 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17554 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17555 does not support resumed sessions.
17556
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017557ssl_c_der : binary
17558 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17559 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17560 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017562ssl_c_err : integer
17563 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17564 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17565 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17566 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17567 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017568
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017569ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017570 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17571 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17572 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17573 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17574 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17575 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17576 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17577 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017578 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17579 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17580 LDAP v3.
17581 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17582 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017584ssl_c_key_alg : string
17585 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17586 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17587 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017589ssl_c_notafter : string
17590 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17591 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17592 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017594ssl_c_notbefore : string
17595 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17596 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17597 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017598
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017599ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017600 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17601 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17602 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17603 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17604 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17605 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17606 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17607 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017608 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17609 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17610 LDAP v3.
17611 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17612 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017614ssl_c_serial : binary
17615 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17616 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17617 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017619ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17620 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17621 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17622 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017623 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17624 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17625
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017626 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017627 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017629ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17630 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17631 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17632 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017634ssl_c_used : boolean
17635 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17636 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017638ssl_c_verify : integer
17639 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17640 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17641 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17642 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017644ssl_c_version : integer
17645 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17646 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017647
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017648ssl_f_der : binary
17649 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17650 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17651 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17652
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017653ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017654 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17655 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17656 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17657 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017658 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017659 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17660 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17661 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017662 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17663 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17664 LDAP v3.
17665 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17666 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017668ssl_f_key_alg : string
17669 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17670 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17671 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017673ssl_f_notafter : string
17674 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17675 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17676 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017678ssl_f_notbefore : string
17679 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17680 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17681 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017682
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017683ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017684 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17685 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17686 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17687 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17688 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17689 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17690 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17691 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017692 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17693 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17694 LDAP v3.
17695 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17696 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017698ssl_f_serial : binary
17699 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17700 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17701 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017702
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017703ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17704 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17705 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17706 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017708ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17709 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17710 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17711 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017713ssl_f_version : integer
17714 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17715 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17716
17717ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017718 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17719 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17720 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017722 Example :
17723 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17724 listen http-https
17725 bind :80
17726 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17727 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17728
17729ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17730 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17731 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17732
17733ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017734 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017735 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17736 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17737 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17738 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17739 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17740 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17741 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17742 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017744ssl_fc_cipher : string
17745 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17746 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017747
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017748ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17749 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17750 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017751 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017752
17753ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17754 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17755 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017756 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017757
17758ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17759 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17760 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17761 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017762 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017763 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017764
17765ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17766 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17767 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017768 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017769
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017770ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17771 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17772 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17773 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17774
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017775ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17776 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17777 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17778 transport layer.
17779 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17780 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17781 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17782 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17783
17784ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17785 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17786 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17787 transport layer.
17788 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17789 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17790 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17791 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17792
17793ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17794 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17795 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17796 transport layer.
17797 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17798 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17799 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17800 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17801
17802ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17803 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17804 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17805 transport layer.
17806 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17807 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17808 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17809 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17810
17811ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17812 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17813 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17814 transport layer.
17815 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17816 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17817 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17818 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017820ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017821 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17822 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017823 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17824 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17825 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17826 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017827
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017828ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17829 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17830 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17831 wait until the handshake happened.
17832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017833ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17834 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017835 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17836 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017837 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017838 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017839
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017840ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017841 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017842 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17843 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017845ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017846 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017847 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17848 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17849 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17850 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17851 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17852 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17853 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017855ssl_fc_protocol : string
17856 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17857 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017858
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017859ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017860 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017861 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17862 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017863
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017864ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17865 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17866 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17867 transport layer.
17868 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17869 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17870 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17871 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17872
17873ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17874 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17875 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17876 transport layer.
17877 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17878 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17879 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17880 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17881
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017882ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17883 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17884 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17885 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017887ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17888 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17889 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17890 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17891 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017892
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017893ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17894 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17895 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17896 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17897 BoringSSL.
17898
17899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017900ssl_fc_sni : string
17901 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17902 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17903 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17904 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17905 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17906
17907 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17908 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17909 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017910 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017911 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017913 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017914 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17915 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017917ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17918 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17919 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017920
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017921ssl_s_der : binary
17922 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17923 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17924 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17925
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017926ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17927 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17928 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17929 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17930 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17931 does not support resumed sessions.
17932
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017933ssl_s_key_alg : string
17934 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17935 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17936 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17937
17938ssl_s_notafter : string
17939 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17940 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17941 transport layer.
17942
17943ssl_s_notbefore : string
17944 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17945 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17946 transport layer.
17947
17948ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17949 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17950 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17951 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17952 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17953 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17954 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017955 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17956 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017957 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17958 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17959 LDAP v3.
17960 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17961 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17962
17963ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17964 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17965 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17966 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17967 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17968 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17969 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017970 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17971 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017972 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17973 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17974 LDAP v3.
17975 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17976 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17977
17978ssl_s_serial : binary
17979 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17980 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17981 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17982
17983ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17984 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17985 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17986 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17987
17988ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17989 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17990 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17991 layer.
17992
17993ssl_s_version : integer
17994 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17995 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017996
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200179977.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017998------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018000Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18001sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18002only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18003For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18004be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18005can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18006sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18007for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18008content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018010payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018011 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018012 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18013 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018015payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18016 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018017 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018018 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018020req.len : integer
18021req_len : integer (deprecated)
18022 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18023 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18024 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18025 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18026 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18027 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18028 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18029 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018031req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18032 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018033 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18034 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18035 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18036 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018038 ACL alternatives :
18039 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018041req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18042 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18043 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18044 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18045 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018047 ACL alternatives :
18048 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018050 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018052req.proto_http : boolean
18053req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18054 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18055 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18056 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18057 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18058 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18059 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18060 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018062 Example:
18063 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18064 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18065 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018066 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018068req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18069rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18070 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18071 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18072 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18073 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18074 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18075 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18076 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018078 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18079 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18080 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18081 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18082 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18083 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018085 ACL derivatives :
18086 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018088 Example :
18089 listen tse-farm
18090 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18091 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18092 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18093 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18094 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18095 persist rdp-cookie
18096 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18097 # This is only useful makes sense if
18098 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18099 stick-table type string size 204800
18100 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18101 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18102 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018104 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18105 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018107req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18108rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18109 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18110 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18111 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18112 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018114 ACL derivatives :
18115 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018116
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018117req.ssl_alpn : string
18118 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18119 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18120 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18121 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18122 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18123 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018124 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018125
18126 Examples :
18127 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18128 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18129 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018130 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018131 default_backend bk_default
18132
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018133req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18134 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18135 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018136 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18137 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18138 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18139 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18140 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018142req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18143req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18144 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18145 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18146 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18147 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18148 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18149 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18150 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018152req.ssl_sni : string
18153req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18154 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18155 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18156 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18157 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18158 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018159 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18160 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18161 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18162 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18163 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18164 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18165 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18166 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18167 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018169 ACL derivatives :
18170 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018172 Examples :
18173 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18174 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18175 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18176 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18177 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018178
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018179req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18180 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18181 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18182 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18183 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18184 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18185 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18186 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18187 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18188 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018190req.ssl_ver : integer
18191req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18192 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18193 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18194 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18195 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18196 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18197 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18198 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018199 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018200 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018202 ACL derivatives :
18203 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018204
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018205res.len : integer
18206 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18207 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18208 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18209 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18210 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18211 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18212 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018213 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018215res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18216 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018217 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018218 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018219 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018220 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018222res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18223 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18224 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18225 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018226 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18227 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018229 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018230
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018231res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18232rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18233 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18234 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18235 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18236 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18237 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18238 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18239 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018241wait_end : boolean
18242 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18243 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018244 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018245 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18246 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018247 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018248 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18249 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018251 Examples :
18252 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18253 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18254 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018256 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18257 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18258 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18259 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18260 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18261 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18262 tcp-request content reject
18263
18264
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200182657.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018266--------------------------------------
18267
18268It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18269This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18270data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18271its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18272HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18273content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18274to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18275more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18276response are indexed.
18277
18278base : string
18279 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18280 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18281 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18282 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18283 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18284 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18285 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18286 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18287
18288 ACL derivatives :
18289 base : exact string match
18290 base_beg : prefix match
18291 base_dir : subdir match
18292 base_dom : domain match
18293 base_end : suffix match
18294 base_len : length match
18295 base_reg : regex match
18296 base_sub : substring match
18297
18298base32 : integer
18299 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18300 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18301 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018302 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18303 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18304 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018305
18306base32+src : binary
18307 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18308 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18309 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18310 per-URL counters.
18311
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018312capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18313 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18314 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18315 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18316
18317capture.req.method : string
18318 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18319 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18320 because it's allocated.
18321
18322capture.req.uri : string
18323 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18324 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18325 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18326 allocated.
18327
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018328capture.req.ver : string
18329 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18330 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18331 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18332
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018333capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18334 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18335 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18336 The first entry is an index of 0.
18337 See also: "capture response header"
18338
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018339capture.res.ver : string
18340 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18341 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18342 persistent flag.
18343
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018344req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018345 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18346 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18347 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018348
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018349req.body_param([<name>) : string
18350 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18351 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18352 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18353 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18354 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18355 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18356 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18357 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18358 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18359 given.
18360
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018361req.body_len : integer
18362 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18363 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018364 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18365 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018366
18367req.body_size : integer
18368 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018369 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18370 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018372req.cook([<name>]) : string
18373cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18374 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18375 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18376 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18377 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18378 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18379 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18380 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18381 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18382
18383 ACL derivatives :
18384 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18385 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18386 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18387 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18388 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18389 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18390 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18391 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018393req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18394cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18395 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18396 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018398req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18399cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18400 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18401 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18402 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18403 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018405cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18406 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18407 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18408 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18409 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018410 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018411 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18412 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18413 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18414 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018416hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18417 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18418 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18419 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18420 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018421 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018423req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
18424 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18425 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18426 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18427 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18428 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18429 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
18430 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
18431 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018433req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18434 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18435 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18436 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18437 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018439req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18440 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18441 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18442 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18443 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18444 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18445 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
18446 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
18447 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000018448 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018449 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018450 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018452 ACL derivatives :
18453 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18454 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18455 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18456 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18457 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18458 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18459 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18460 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18461
18462req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18463hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18464 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18465 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
18466 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
18467 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
18468 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
18469 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
18470 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
18471 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
18472 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
18473
18474req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18475hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18476 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18477 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18478 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
18479 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18480 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018481 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018482 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
18483 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
18484
18485req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18486hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18487 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18488 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18489 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
18490 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18491 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18492 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18493 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
18494
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018495req.hdrs : string
18496 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
18497 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18498 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18499 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
18500
18501req.hdrs_bin : binary
18502 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18503 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
18504 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
18505 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
18506 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
18507 names and values (length of 0 for both).
18508
18509 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018510
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018511 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18512 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018514http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18515 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18516 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18517 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18518 basic auth is supported.
18519
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018520http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18521 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18522 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18523 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18524 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018525 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18526 basic auth is supported.
18527
18528 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018529 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18530 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18531 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18532 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018533
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018534http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018535 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18536 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18537 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018538
18539http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018540 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18541 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18542 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018543
18544http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018545 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18546 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18547 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018549http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018550 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18551 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018552 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18553 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018555method : integer + string
18556 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18557 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18558 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18559 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18560 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18561 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18562 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018564 ACL derivatives :
18565 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018567 Example :
18568 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18569 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18570 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018572path : string
18573 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18574 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18575 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18576 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18577 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018578 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018579 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018581 ACL derivatives :
18582 path : exact string match
18583 path_beg : prefix match
18584 path_dir : subdir match
18585 path_dom : domain match
18586 path_end : suffix match
18587 path_len : length match
18588 path_reg : regex match
18589 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018590
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018591pathq : string
18592 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18593 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18594 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18595 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18596 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18597 result in both cases.
18598
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018599query : string
18600 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18601 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18602 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18603 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018604 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018605 which stops before the question mark.
18606
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018607req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18608 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18609 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18610 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18611 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018613req.ver : string
18614req_ver : string (deprecated)
18615 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18616 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18617 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018619 ACL derivatives :
18620 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018621
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018622res.body : binary
18623 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18624 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18625 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18626 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18627
18628res.body_len : integer
18629 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18630 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18631 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18632 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18633
18634res.body_size : integer
18635 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18636 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18637 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18638 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18639 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18640 based expect rules.
18641
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010018642res.cache_hit : boolean
18643 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
18644 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
18645
18646res.cache_name : string
18647 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
18648 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
18649 empty string.
18650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018651res.comp : boolean
18652 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18653 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18654 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018656res.comp_algo : string
18657 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18658 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18659 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018661res.cook([<name>]) : string
18662scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18663 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18664 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018665 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18666 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018668 ACL derivatives :
18669 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018671res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18672scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18673 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18674 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018675 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18676 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018678res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18679scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18680 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18681 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018682 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18683 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018685res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18686 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18687 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18688 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18689 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18690 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18691 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18692 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18693 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018694 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018696res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18697 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18698 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18699 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18700 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018701 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18702 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018704res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18705shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18706 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18707 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18708 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18709 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18710 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18711 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18712 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018713 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18714 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018716 ACL derivatives :
18717 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18718 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18719 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18720 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18721 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18722 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18723 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18724 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18725
18726res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18727shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18728 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18729 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18730 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18731 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018732 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018734res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18735shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18736 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18737 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18738 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18739 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18740 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018741 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18742 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018743
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018744res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18745 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18746 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18747 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018748 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18749 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018751res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18752shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18753 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18754 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18755 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18756 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18757 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018758 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18759 based expect rules.
18760
18761res.hdrs : string
18762 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18763 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18764 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18765 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18766 based expect rules.
18767
18768res.hdrs_bin : binary
18769 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18770 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18771 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18772 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18773 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18774 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18775 (length of 0 for both).
18776
18777 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18778
18779 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18780 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018782res.ver : string
18783resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18784 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018785 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18786 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018788 ACL derivatives :
18789 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018791set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18792 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18793 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018794 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018795 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018797 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18798 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018800status : integer
18801 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18802 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018803 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18804 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018805
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018806unique-id : string
18807 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18808 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18809 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18810 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18811 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18812 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018814url : string
18815 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18816 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18817 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18818 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18819 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18820 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18821 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018823 ACL derivatives :
18824 url : exact string match
18825 url_beg : prefix match
18826 url_dir : subdir match
18827 url_dom : domain match
18828 url_end : suffix match
18829 url_len : length match
18830 url_reg : regex match
18831 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018833url_ip : ip
18834 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18835 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18836 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18837 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18838 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18839 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18840 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018842url_port : integer
18843 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18844 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18845 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18846 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018847
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018848urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18849url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018850 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18851 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018852 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18853 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18854 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18855 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018856 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18857 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018858 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18859 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018861 ACL derivatives :
18862 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18863 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18864 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18865 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18866 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18867 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18868 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18869 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018870
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018872 Example :
18873 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18874 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18875 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18876 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018877
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018878urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018879 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18880 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18881 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018882
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018883url32 : integer
18884 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18885 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18886 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18887 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18888 is an unsigned integer.
18889
18890url32+src : binary
18891 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18892 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18893 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18894
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018895
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200188967.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018897---------------------------------------
18898
18899This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18900used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18901purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18902There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18903or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18904any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18905for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18906
18907internal.htx.data : integer
18908 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18909 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18910
18911internal.htx.free : integer
18912 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18913 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18914
18915internal.htx.free_data : integer
18916 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18917 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18918
18919internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18920 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18921 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18922 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18923
18924internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18925 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18926 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18927
18928internal.htx.size : integer
18929 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18930 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18931
18932internal.htx.used : integer
18933 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18934 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18935 direction.
18936
18937internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18938 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18939 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18940 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18941 of the special value :
18942 * head : The oldest inserted block
18943 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018944 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018945
18946internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18947 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18948 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18949 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18950 integer or one of the special value :
18951 * head : The oldest inserted block
18952 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018953 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018954
18955internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18956 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18957 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18958 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18959 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18960
18961 * head : The oldest inserted block
18962 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018963 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018964
18965internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18966 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18967 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18968 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18969 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18970
18971 * head : The oldest inserted block
18972 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018973 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018974
18975internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18976 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18977 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18978 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18979 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18980
18981 * head : The oldest inserted block
18982 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018983 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018984
18985internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18986 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18987 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18988 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18989 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18990
18991 * head : The oldest inserted block
18992 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018993 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018994
18995internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18996 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18997 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18998 it returns false.
18999
19000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200190017.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019002---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019004Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19005every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019006order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019008ACL name Equivalent to Usage
19009---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019010FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020019011HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019012HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
19013HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019014HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
19015HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19016HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19017HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19018LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019019METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020019020METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019021METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19022METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19023METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19024METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020019025METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019026METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020019027RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019028REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019029TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019030WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19031---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019032
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190348. Logging
19035----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019036
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019037One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19038provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19039very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19040provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19041state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019042to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019043headers.
19044
19045In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19046about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19047send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19048
19049 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19050 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19051 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19052 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19053 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019054 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019055 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019056
19057The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19058allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19059as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19060while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19061real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19062delay.
19063
19064
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190658.1. Log levels
19066---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019067
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019068TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019069source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019070HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19071in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19072track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19073syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19074about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019075
19076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190778.2. Log formats
19078----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019079
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019080HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019081and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19082slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19083options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019084
19085 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19086 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19087 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19088 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19089 extents.
19090
19091 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19092 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19093 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19094 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19095 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19096
19097 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19098 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19099 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19100 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19101 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19102
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019103 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19104 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19105 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19106 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19107
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019108 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019110Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19111specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19112field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19113servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19114always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19115identifier.
19116
19117Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19118 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19119 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19120 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19121 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19122
19123
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191248.2.1. Default log format
19125-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019126
19127This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19128as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19129format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19130
19131 Example :
19132 listen www
19133 mode http
19134 log global
19135 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19136
19137 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19138 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19139 (www/HTTP)
19140
19141 Field Format Extract from the example above
19142 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19143 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19144 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19145 4 'to' to
19146 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19147 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19148
19149Detailed fields description :
19150 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19151 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19152 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19153 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19154 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19155 and processed the connection.
19156 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19157
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019158In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19159"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19160connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19161
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019162It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19163will eventually disappear.
19164
19165
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191668.2.2. TCP log format
19167---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019168
19169The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19170is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19171information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19172counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19173emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19174environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19175the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19176sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019177specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19178not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19179fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19180marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019181
19182 Example :
19183 frontend fnt
19184 mode tcp
19185 option tcplog
19186 log global
19187 default_backend bck
19188
19189 backend bck
19190 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19191
19192 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19193 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19194 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19195
19196 Field Format Extract from the example above
19197 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19198 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19199 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19200 4 frontend_name fnt
19201 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19202 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19203 7 bytes_read* 212
19204 8 termination_state --
19205 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19206 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19207
19208Detailed fields description :
19209 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019210 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19211 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19212 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019213 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019214 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019215 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019216
19217 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019218 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19219 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19220 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019221
19222 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19223 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19224 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019225 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19226 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19227 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19228 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019229
19230 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19231 and processed the connection.
19232
19233 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19234 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19235 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19236 applications.
19237
19238 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19239 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19240 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19241 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19242 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19243
19244 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19245 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19246 See "Timers" below for more details.
19247
19248 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19249 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19250 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19251 "Timers" below for more details.
19252
19253 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019254 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019255 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19256 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19257 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19258 details.
19259
19260 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19261 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19262 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19263 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19264 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19265
19266 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19267 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19268 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19269 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19270 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19271 for more details.
19272
19273 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019274 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019275 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19276 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19277 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019278 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019279
19280 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19281 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19282 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19283 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19284 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19285 caused by a denial of service attack.
19286
19287 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19288 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19289 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19290 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19291 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19292 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19293 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19294 denial of service attack.
19295
19296 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19297 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19298 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19299 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19300 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19301 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19302 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19303 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19304 be processed than on other servers.
19305
19306 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19307 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19308 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19309 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19310 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19311 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19312 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19313 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19314 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19315 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19316 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19317 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19318 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19319
19320 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19321 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19322 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19323 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19324 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19325 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019326 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019327 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19328
19329 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19330 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19331 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19332 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19333 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19334 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019335 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019336 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19337 occurs.
19338
19339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193408.2.3. HTTP log format
19341----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019342
19343The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19344is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19345the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19346are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19347emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19348generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19349"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19350which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019351frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19352is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019353
19354Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19355slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19356with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19357
19358 Example :
19359 frontend http-in
19360 mode http
19361 option httplog
19362 log global
19363 default_backend bck
19364
19365 backend static
19366 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19367
19368 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19369 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19370 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019371 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019372
19373 Field Format Extract from the example above
19374 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19375 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019376 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019377 4 frontend_name http-in
19378 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019379 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019380 7 status_code 200
19381 8 bytes_read* 2750
19382 9 captured_request_cookie -
19383 10 captured_response_cookie -
19384 11 termination_state ----
19385 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19386 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19387 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19388 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19389 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019390
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019391Detailed fields description :
19392 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019393 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19394 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19395 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019396 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019397 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019398 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019399
19400 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019401 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19402 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19403 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019404
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019405 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
19406 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019407
19408 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19409 and processed the connection.
19410
19411 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19412 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19413 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
19414
19415 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19416 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19417 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19418 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
19419 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
19420 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
19421
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019422 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
19423 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
19424 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019425 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019426 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
19427 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019428 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
19429 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019430
19431 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19432 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019433 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019434
19435 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19436 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019437 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
19438 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019439
19440 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
19441 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
19442 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
19443 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
19444 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019445 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
19446 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019447
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019448 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
19449 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
19450 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
19451 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
19452 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
19453 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
19454 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019455 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019456
19457 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19458 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19459 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19460
19461 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19462 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019463 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019464 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19465 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19466 overflowing.
19467
19468 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19469 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19470 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19471 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19472 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19473 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19474 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19475 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19476
19477 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19478 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19479 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19480 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19481 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19482 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19483 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19484 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19485
19486 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19487 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19488 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19489 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19490 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19491 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19492 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19493
19494 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019495 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019496 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19497 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19498 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019499 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019500 system.
19501
19502 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19503 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19504 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19505 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19506 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19507 caused by a denial of service attack.
19508
19509 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19510 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19511 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19512 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19513 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19514 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19515 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19516 denial of service attack.
19517
19518 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19519 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19520 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19521 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19522 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19523 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19524 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19525 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19526 processed than on other servers.
19527
19528 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19529 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19530 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19531 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19532 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19533 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19534 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19535 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19536 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19537 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19538 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19539 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19540 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19541
19542 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19543 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19544 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19545 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19546 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19547 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019548 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019549 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19550
19551 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19552 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19553 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19554 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19555 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19556 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019557 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019558 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19559 occurs.
19560
19561 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19562 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19563 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19564 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19565 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19566 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19567 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19568 cookies" below for more details.
19569
19570 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19571 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19572 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19573 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19574 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19575 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19576 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19577 and cookies" below for more details.
19578
19579 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19580 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19581 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19582 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19583 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19584 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19585 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19586 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19587
19588
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200195898.2.4. Custom log format
19590------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019591
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019592The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019593mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019594
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019595HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019596Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19597separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19598prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19599
19600Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19601variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019602("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019603
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019604If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019605as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019606less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19607the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19608
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019609Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19610"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19611delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19612preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019613
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019614Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19615'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19616https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19617such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19618
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019619Flags are :
19620 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019621 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019622 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19623 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019624
19625 Example:
19626
19627 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19628 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19629
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019630 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19631
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019632At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19633
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019634 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19635 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019636
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019637the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019638
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019639 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19640 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19641 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019642
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019643and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19644
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019645 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19646 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019647
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019648Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19649
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019650 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019651 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019652 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19653 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19654 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019655 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19656 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19657 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019658 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019659 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000019660 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000019661 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019662 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019663 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19664 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019665 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019666 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019667 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019668 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019669 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019670 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019671 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019672 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19673 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19674 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19675 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19676 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019677 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019678 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019679 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019680 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019681 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019682 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19683 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019684 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19685 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19686 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019687 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019688 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19689 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019690 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019691 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19692 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19693 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019694 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019695 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019696 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19697 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19698 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19699 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019700 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019701 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019702 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019703 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019704 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019705 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019706 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19707 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19708 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019709 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019710 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19711 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019712 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019713 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19714 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019715 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019716 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019717 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019718 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019719
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019720 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019721
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019722
197238.2.5. Error log format
19724-----------------------
19725
19726When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19727protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19728By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19729"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019730will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019731logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19732
19733The format looks like this :
19734
19735 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19736 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19737 Connection error during SSL handshake
19738
19739 Field Format Extract from the example above
19740 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19741 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19742 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19743 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19744 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19745
19746These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19747failures.
19748
19749
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197508.3. Advanced logging options
19751-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019752
19753Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19754just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19755options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19756for more information about their usage.
19757
19758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197598.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19760------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019761
19762It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19763haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19764commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19765monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19766ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19767
19768 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19769 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19770 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19771 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19772
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020019773 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
19774 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019775
19776 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19777 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19778 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19779
19780
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197818.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19782----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019783
19784The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19785what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19786or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019787"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019788just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19789log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19790after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19791is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19792with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19793with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19794
19795
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197968.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19797------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019798
19799Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19800for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19801"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19802retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19803raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19804a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19805file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19806you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19807"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19808
19809
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198108.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19811--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019812
19813Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19814multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19815them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19816"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19817logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19818error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19819and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19820too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19821useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19822alternative.
19823
19824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198258.4. Timing events
19826------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019827
19828Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19829reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19830the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19831frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019832mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19833addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19834
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019835Timings events in HTTP mode:
19836
19837 first request 2nd request
19838 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19839 t tr t tr ...
19840 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19841 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19842 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19843 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019844 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019845 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19846
19847Timings events in TCP mode:
19848
19849 TCP session
19850 |<----------------->|
19851 t t
19852 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19853 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19854 |<------ Tt ------->|
19855
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019856 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019857 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019858 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19859 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19860 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019861 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019862 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19863 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19864 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19865 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019866
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019867 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19868 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19869 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019870 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19871 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19872 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19873 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19874 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19875 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019876
19877 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19878 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19879 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19880 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19881 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19882 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19883 request typed by hand during a test.
19884
19885 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19886 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019887 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019888 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19889 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19890 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19891 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019892
19893 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19894 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19895 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19896 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19897 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19898
19899 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19900 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19901 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19902 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19903 connection never established.
19904
19905 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19906 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19907 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19908 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19909 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19910 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19911 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19912 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19913 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19914 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19915 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19916
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019917 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19918 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19919 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19920 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19921 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19922 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19923
19924 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19925
19926 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19927 "Ta" can never be negative.
19928
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019929 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19930 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019931 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19932 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019933 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019934
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019935 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019936
19937 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019938 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19939 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019940
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019941 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19942 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19943 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19944 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19945 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19946 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19947 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19948 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19949
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019950These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19951protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19952that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019953due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19954"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19955that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019956
19957Most common cases :
19958
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019959 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19960 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19961 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19962 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19963 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19964 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19965 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19966 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19967 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19968 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19969 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019970 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019971
19972 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19973 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19974 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19975 of ms on remote networks.
19976
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019977 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19978 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19979 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019980
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019981 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19982 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19983 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19984 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19985 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19986 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19987 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19988 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19989 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019990
19991Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19992
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019993 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019994 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019995 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019996
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019997 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019998 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19999 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20000
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020001 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020002 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20003 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20004 flags.
20005
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020006 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20007 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020008 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20009 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20010 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20011 the client connection was maintained open.
20012
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020013 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020014 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020015 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020016 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20017
20018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200198.5. Session state at disconnection
20020-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020021
20022TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20023"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
200242-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20025each of which has a special meaning :
20026
20027 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20028 session to terminate :
20029
20030 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20031
20032 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20033 server explicitly refused it.
20034
20035 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20036 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20037 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20038 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020039 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020040
20041 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20042 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020043
20044 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20045 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20046 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20047 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20048 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20049
20050 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20051 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20052 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20053 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20054 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20055
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020056 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20057 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20058
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020059 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20060 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20061 backup connections when going up.
20062
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020063 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20064
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020065 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20066 send or receive data.
20067
20068 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20069 send or receive data.
20070
20071 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20072 with nothing left in the buffers.
20073
20074 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20075
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020076 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020077 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20078
20079 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20080 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20081 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20082 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20083 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20084
20085 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20086 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20087
20088 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20089 server (HTTP only).
20090
20091 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20092
20093 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20094 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20095 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20096
20097 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20098 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20099 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20100
20101 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20102
20103 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20104 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20105
20106 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20107 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20108 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20109
20110 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20111 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020112 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20113 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020114
20115 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20116 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20117 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20118 another server.
20119
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020120 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020121 server.
20122
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020123 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20124 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20125 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20126 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20127
20128 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20129 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20130 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20131 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20132
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020133 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20134 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20135 "use-server" rule).
20136
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020137 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20138
20139 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20140 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20141
20142 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20143
20144 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20145 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20146 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20147
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020148 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20149 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020150 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020151 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20152 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20153
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020154 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20155
20156 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20157 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20158
20159 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20160
20161 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20162
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020163The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20164was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020165helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20166starvation, attacks, etc...
20167
20168The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20169alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20170easier finding and understanding.
20171
20172 Flags Reason
20173
20174 -- Normal termination.
20175
20176 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20177 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20178 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20179 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20180
20181 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20182 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20183 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20184 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20185 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20186 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020187
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020188 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20189 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020190 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020191
20192 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20193 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20194 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20195
20196 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20197 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20198 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20199 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20200 the server takes too long to respond.
20201
20202 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20203 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20204 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20205 long a time to respond.
20206
20207 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20208 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20209 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20210 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020211 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20212 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020213
20214 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20215 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20216 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20217 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20218 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020219 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020220 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20221 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20222 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20223 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20224 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20225 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20226 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20227 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020228 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020229 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20230 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20231 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020232
20233 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20234 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020235 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20236 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20237 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20238 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020239
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020240 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20241 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20242
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020243 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020244 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20245 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020246 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020247 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20248 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20249
20250 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20251 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20252 503 or 504 here.
20253
20254 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20255 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20256 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20257 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20258 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20259
20260 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20261 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020262 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020263 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20264 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20265
20266 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20267 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20268 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20269 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20270 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20271 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20272 between haproxy and the server.
20273
20274 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20275 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20276 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20277 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20278 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20279 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20280 solution is to fix the application.
20281
20282 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20283 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20284 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20285 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20286 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20287 external attacks.
20288
20289 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
20290 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020291 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020292 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20293 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20294
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020295 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20296 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20297 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020298 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020299 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020300
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020301 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20302 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20303 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20304 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020305 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20306 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20307 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20308 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20309 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020310
20311 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20312 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20313 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20314 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20315
20316 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20317 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20318 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20319 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20320
20321 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20322 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20323 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20324 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20325
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020326The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20327persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20328important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20329re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20330
20331 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20332
20333 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20334 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20335 set on a GET request.
20336
20337 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20338 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020339 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020340 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20341
20342 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20343 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20344 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20345
20346 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20347 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20348 already got a cookie.
20349
20350 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20351 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20352 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20353 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20354 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20355
20356 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20357 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20358 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20359
20360 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20361 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20362 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20363
20364 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20365 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20366
20367 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20368 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20369 then advertised in the response.
20370
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203728.6. Non-printable characters
20373-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020374
20375In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20376consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20377converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20378prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20379being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20380escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20381is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20382'}' when logging headers.
20383
20384Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20385issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20386containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20387
20388Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20389the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20390performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20391
20392
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203938.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20394---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020395
20396Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20397achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020398section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020399cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20400the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20401the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020402locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020403not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20404user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20405a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
20406wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
20407
20408 Examples :
20409 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
20410 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
20411
20412 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
20413 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
20414
20415
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204168.8. Capturing HTTP headers
20417---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020418
20419Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
20420proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
20421the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
20422server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
20423
20424Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
20425response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020426section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020427
20428It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020429time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
20430appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020431are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
20432and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
20433follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
20434request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
20435in the logs.
20436
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020437As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
20438frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
20439an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
20440
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020441 Example :
20442 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
20443 listen proxy-out
20444 mode http
20445 option httplog
20446 option logasap
20447 log global
20448 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
20449
20450 # log the name of the virtual server
20451 capture request header Host len 20
20452
20453 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
20454 capture request header Content-Length len 10
20455
20456 # log the beginning of the referrer
20457 capture request header Referer len 20
20458
20459 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20460 capture response header Server len 20
20461
20462 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20463 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20464
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020465 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020466 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20467
20468 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20469 capture response header Via len 20
20470
20471 # log the URL location during a redirection
20472 capture response header Location len 20
20473
20474 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20475 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20476 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20477 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20478 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20479
20480 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20481 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20482 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20483 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020484 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020485
20486 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20487 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20488 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20489 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20490 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020491 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020492
20493
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204948.9. Examples of logs
20495---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020496
20497These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20498them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20499reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20500
20501 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20502 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20503 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20504
20505 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20506 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20507
20508 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20509 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20510 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20511
20512 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20513 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20514
20515 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20516 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20517 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20518
20519 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020520 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020521 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20522 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20523
20524 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20525 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20526 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20527
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020528 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20529 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20530 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20531 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20532 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20533 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020534
20535 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020536 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020537
20538 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20539 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20540 Nothing was sent to any server.
20541
20542 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20543 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20544
20545 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20546 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020547 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020548 send a 408 return code to the client.
20549
20550 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20551 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20552
20553 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20554 5 seconds ("c----").
20555
20556 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20557 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020558 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020559
20560 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020561 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020562 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20563 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20564 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20565 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20566 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020567
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020568
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200205699. Supported filters
20570--------------------
20571
20572Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20573accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20574unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20575
20576See also : "filter"
20577
205789.1. Trace
20579----------
20580
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010020581filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020582
20583 Arguments:
20584 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20585 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20586
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010020587 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020588
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020589 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020590 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20591 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20592 amount of the parsed data.
20593
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020594 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020595
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020596This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20597callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20598information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20599filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20600
20601Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20602tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20603a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20604
20605
206069.2. HTTP compression
20607---------------------
20608
20609filter compression
20610
20611The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20612keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020613when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20614fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20615done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20616explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20617filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20618listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20619order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020620
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020621See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20622 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020623
20624
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200206259.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20626--------------------------------------------
20627
20628filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20629
20630 Arguments :
20631
20632 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20633 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20634 parsed.
20635
20636 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20637 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20638 part must be placed in its own scope.
20639
20640The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20641external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020642streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020643exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20644also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20645
20646SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20647the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20648
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020649For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020650"doc/SPOE.txt".
20651
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100206529.4. Cache
20653----------
20654
20655filter cache <name>
20656
20657 Arguments :
20658
20659 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20660
20661The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20662"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020663cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020664other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20665case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20666is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20667filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020668listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20669order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020670
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020671See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20672 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20673
20674
206759.5. Fcgi-app
20676-------------
20677
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020678filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020679
20680 Arguments :
20681
20682 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20683
20684The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20685request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20686reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20687used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20688implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20689used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20690fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20691used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20692order.
20693
20694See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20695 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20696
20697
2069810. FastCGI applications
20699-------------------------
20700
20701HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20702feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20703the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20704FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20705servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20706FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20707backend.
20708
20709HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20710application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20711connection.
20712
2071310.1. Setup
20714-----------
20715
2071610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20717--------------------------
20718
20719fcgi-app <name>
20720 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20721 document root must be defined.
20722
20723acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20724 Declare or complete an access list.
20725
20726 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20727 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20728 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20729 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20730 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20731
20732docroot <path>
20733 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20734 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20735 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20736
20737index <script-name>
20738 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20739 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20740 is an optional setting.
20741
20742 Example :
20743 index index.php
20744
20745log-stderr global
20746log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20747 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20748 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20749
20750 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20751 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20752
20753pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20754 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20755 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20756 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20757
20758 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20759 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20760 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20761 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20762
20763 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20764 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20765
20766path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020767 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020768 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20769 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20770 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20771 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20772 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20773 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20774 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020775
20776 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020777 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020778 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20779 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20780 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20781 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020782
20783 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020784 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20785 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020786
20787option get-values
20788no option get-values
20789 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20790
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020791 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020792 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20793
20794 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20795 application will accept.
20796
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020797 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20798 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020799
20800 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020801 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020802 option is disabled.
20803
20804 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20805 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20806 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20807 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20808 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20809 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20810
20811option keep-conn
20812no option keep-conn
20813 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20814 sending a response.
20815
20816 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20817 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20818
20819option max-reqs <reqs>
20820 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20821 accept.
20822
20823 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20824 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20825 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20826 to 1.
20827
20828option mpxs-conns
20829no option mpxs-conns
20830 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20831
20832 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20833 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20834
20835set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20836 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20837 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20838 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20839 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20840
20841 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20842 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20843 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20844
20845 Example :
20846 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20847 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20848
20849 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20850
20851
2085210.1.2. Proxy section
20853---------------------
20854
20855use-fcgi-app <name>
20856 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20857
20858 Arguments :
20859 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20860
20861 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20862 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20863 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20864 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20865 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20866
20867 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20868 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20869 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20870 application are evaluated.
20871
20872
2087310.1.3. Example
20874---------------
20875
20876 frontend front-http
20877 mode http
20878 bind *:80
20879 bind *:
20880
20881 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20882 default_backend back-static
20883
20884 backend back-static
20885 mode http
20886 server www A.B.C.D:80
20887
20888 backend back-dynamic
20889 mode http
20890 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20891 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20892
20893 fcgi-app php-fpm
20894 log-stderr global
20895 option keep-conn
20896
20897 docroot /var/www/my-app
20898 index index.php
20899 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20900
20901
2090210.2. Default parameters
20903------------------------
20904
20905A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20906the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020907script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020908applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20909
20910 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20911 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20912 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20913 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20914 | | |
20915 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20916 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20917 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20918 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20919 | | application. |
20920 | | |
20921 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20922 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20923 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20924 | | |
20925 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20926 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20927 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20928 | | the application's configuration. |
20929 | | |
20930 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20931 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20932 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20933 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20934 | | |
20935 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20936 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20937 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20938 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20939 | | be defined. |
20940 | | |
20941 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20942 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20943 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20944 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20945 | | is not set too. |
20946 | | |
20947 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20948 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20949 | | set. |
20950 | | |
20951 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20952 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20953 | | the request. |
20954 | | |
20955 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20956 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20957 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20958 | | |
20959 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20960 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20961 | | script to process the request. |
20962 | | |
20963 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20964 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20965 | | |
20966 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20967 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20968 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20969 | | |
20970 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20971 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20972 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20973 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20974 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20975 | | |
20976 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20977 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20978 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20979 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20980 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20981 | | side. |
20982 | | |
20983 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20984 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20985 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20986 | | connected to. |
20987 | | |
20988 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20989 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20990 | | |
20991 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20992 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20993 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20994 | | |
20995 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20996
20997
2099810.3. Limitations
20999------------------
21000
21001The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21002way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21003during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21004establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21005application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21006or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21007message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21008these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21009and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21010
21011Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21012request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21013requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21014
21015About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21016into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21017fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21018"http-request" ones.
21019
21020Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21021FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21022processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21023must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21024here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021025
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021026/*
21027 * Local variables:
21028 * fill-column: 79
21029 * End:
21030 */